2.9
[glibc/nacl-glibc.git] / manual / texinfo.tex
blobc49e670b02db360f171da3efcfb64ee430086c0a
1 % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
3 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
4 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
6 \def\texinfoversion{2007-09-03.05}
8 % Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 2007,
9 % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006,
10 % 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12 % This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or
13 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
14 % published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the
15 % License, or (at your option) any later version.
17 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
18 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
19 % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
20 % General Public License for more details.
22 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
23 % along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
25 % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
26 % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
27 % restriction. (This has been our intent since Texinfo was invented.)
29 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
30 % reports; you can get the latest version from:
31 % http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page), or
32 % ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex
33 % (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org).
34 % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
35 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
37 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a
38 % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
39 % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
41 % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
42 % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple
43 % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
44 % tex foo.texi
45 % texindex foo.??
46 % tex foo.texi
47 % tex foo.texi
48 % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
49 % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
50 % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
51 % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
53 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
54 % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
55 % full Texinfo distribution.
57 % The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
60 \message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:}
62 % If in a .fmt file, print the version number
63 % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
64 % they might have appeared in the input file name.
65 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}%
66 \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
69 \chardef\other=12
71 % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
72 % For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
73 \let\+ = \relax
75 % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
76 \let\ptexb=\b
77 \let\ptexbullet=\bullet
78 \let\ptexc=\c
79 \let\ptexcomma=\,
80 \let\ptexdot=\.
81 \let\ptexdots=\dots
82 \let\ptexend=\end
83 \let\ptexequiv=\equiv
84 \let\ptexexclam=\!
85 \let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
86 \let\ptexgtr=>
87 \let\ptexhat=^
88 \let\ptexi=\i
89 \let\ptexindent=\indent
90 \let\ptexinsert=\insert
91 \let\ptexlbrace=\{
92 \let\ptexless=<
93 \let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
94 \let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
95 \let\ptexplus=+
96 \let\ptexrbrace=\}
97 \let\ptexslash=\/
98 \let\ptexstar=\*
99 \let\ptext=\t
101 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
102 % starts a new line in the output.
103 \newlinechar = `^^J
105 % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
106 % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
108 \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
109 \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0.
110 \else
111 \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space}
114 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
115 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi
116 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi
117 \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi
118 \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi
119 \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi
120 \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi
121 \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi
122 \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi
123 \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi
124 \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi
125 \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi
126 \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi
127 \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi
128 \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi
129 \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi
130 \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi
131 \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi
132 \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi
133 \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi
135 \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi
136 \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi
137 \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi
138 \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi
139 \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi
140 \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi
141 \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi
142 \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi
143 \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi
144 \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi
145 \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi
146 \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi
148 \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi
149 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi
150 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi
151 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi
152 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi
154 % Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful.
155 \chardef\spacecat = 10
156 \def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =\spacecat}
158 % sometimes characters are active, so we need control sequences.
159 \chardef\colonChar = `\:
160 \chardef\commaChar = `\,
161 \chardef\dashChar = `\-
162 \chardef\dotChar = `\.
163 \chardef\exclamChar= `\!
164 \chardef\lquoteChar= `\`
165 \chardef\questChar = `\?
166 \chardef\rquoteChar= `\'
167 \chardef\semiChar = `\;
168 \chardef\underChar = `\_
170 % Ignore a token.
172 \def\gobble#1{}
174 % The following is used inside several \edef's.
175 \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
177 % Hyphenation fixes.
178 \hyphenation{
179 Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
180 ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
181 data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
182 man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
183 par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
184 spell-ing spell-ings
185 stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
186 wide-spread wrap-around
189 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
190 \newdimen\bindingoffset
191 \newdimen\normaloffset
192 \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
194 % For a final copy, take out the rectangles
195 % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
196 % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
198 \def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt}
200 % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
201 % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
202 % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
203 % have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
204 % vertical list for the beginning and end of each change).
206 \def\|{%
207 % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
208 \leavevmode
210 % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
211 \vadjust{%
212 % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
213 % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
214 \vskip-\baselineskip
216 % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
217 % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
218 \llap{%
220 % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
221 \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt
223 % This is the space between the bar and the text.
224 \hskip 12pt
229 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
230 % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
231 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
232 % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
233 % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
235 \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
236 \def\loggingall{%
237 \tracingstats2
238 \tracingpages1
239 \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
240 \tracingparagraphs1
241 \tracingoutput1
242 \tracingmacros2
243 \tracingrestores1
244 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
245 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined\else % etex gives us more logging
246 \tracingscantokens1
247 \tracingifs1
248 \tracinggroups1
249 \tracingnesting2
250 \tracingassigns1
252 \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
253 \errorcontextlines16
256 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
257 % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
259 \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount
260 \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi}
261 \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount
262 \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi}
263 \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount
264 \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi}
266 % For @cropmarks command.
267 % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks.
269 \newif\ifcropmarks
270 \let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue
272 % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners.
273 % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986
275 \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
276 \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc
277 \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt
278 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in
280 % Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor.
281 % We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark.
282 % This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark.
284 % A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct.
285 % \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase.
287 % Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter
288 % (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top
289 % of a page, or that at the bottom of a page. The solution is
290 % described on page 260 of The TeXbook. It involves outputting two
291 % marks for the sectioning macros, one before the section break, and
292 % one after. I won't pretend I can describe this better than DEK...
293 \def\domark{%
294 \toks0=\expandafter{\lastchapterdefs}%
295 \toks2=\expandafter{\lastsectiondefs}%
296 \toks4=\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}%
297 \toks6=\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}%
298 \toks8=\expandafter{\lastcolordefs}%
299 \mark{%
300 \the\toks0 \the\toks2
301 \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6
302 \noexpand\else \the\toks8
305 % \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title
306 % page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us
307 % the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g.,
308 % @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very
309 % first @chapter.
310 \def\gettopheadingmarks{%
311 \ifcase0\topmark\fi
312 \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi
314 \def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi}
315 \def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\topmark\fi}
317 % Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors.
318 \def\lastchapterdefs{}
319 \def\lastsectiondefs{}
320 \def\prevchapterdefs{}
321 \def\prevsectiondefs{}
322 \def\lastcolordefs{}
324 % Main output routine.
325 \chardef\PAGE = 255
326 \output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
328 \newbox\headlinebox
329 \newbox\footlinebox
331 % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents
332 % does insertions, but you have to call it yourself.
333 \def\onepageout#1{%
334 \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi
336 \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset
337 \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi
339 % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
340 % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
341 \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
342 \setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}%
343 \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi
344 \setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}%
347 % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
348 % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
349 % before the \shipout runs.
351 \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
352 \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
353 % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
354 % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this:
355 % \entry{{\tt \indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
356 % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in;
357 % it needs to be
358 % {\code {{\tt \backslashcurfont }acronym}
359 \shipout\vbox{%
360 % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
361 \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi
363 \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup
364 \hsize = \outerhsize
365 \vskip-\topandbottommargin
366 \vtop to0pt{%
367 \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}%
368 \nointerlineskip
369 \line{%
370 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}%
371 \hfill
372 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}%
374 \vss}%
375 \vskip\topandbottommargin
376 \line\bgroup
377 \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize.
378 \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi
379 \vbox\bgroup
382 \unvbox\headlinebox
383 \pagebody{#1}%
384 \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt
385 % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
386 % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.)
387 % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
388 \vskip 24pt
389 \unvbox\footlinebox
392 \ifcropmarks
393 \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup
394 \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup
395 \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill
396 \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick
397 \vbox to0pt{\vss
398 \line{%
399 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}%
400 \hfill
401 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}%
403 \nointerlineskip
404 \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}%
406 \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause
408 }% end of \shipout\vbox
409 }% end of group with \indexdummies
410 \advancepageno
411 \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
414 \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen
416 \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}}
417 {\catcode`\@ =11
418 \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
419 % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
420 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
421 \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
422 \dimen@=\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax
423 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
424 \ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
427 % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are
428 % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize
429 % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986)
431 \def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong}
432 \def\nstop{\vbox
433 {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}}
434 \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong}
435 \def\nsbot{\vbox
436 {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}}
438 % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
439 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
440 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
442 \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
443 \def\parseargusing#1#2{%
444 \def\argtorun{#2}%
445 \begingroup
446 \obeylines
447 \spaceisspace
449 \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
452 {\obeylines %
453 \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{%
454 \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
455 \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
459 % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment.
460 \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
461 \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
463 % Each occurence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
465 % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
466 % @end itemize @c foo
467 % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
468 % by \finishparsearg.
470 \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M}
471 \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M}
472 \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{%
473 \def\temp{#3}%
474 \ifx\temp\empty
475 % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
476 \let\temp\finishparsearg
477 \else
478 \let\temp\argcheckspaces
480 % Put the space token in:
481 \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm
484 % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
485 % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
486 % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
487 % just before passing the control to \argtorun.
488 % (Similarily, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
489 % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
490 % that a pair of braces would be stripped.
492 % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
494 \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
496 % \parseargdef\foo{...}
497 % is roughly equivalent to
498 % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
499 % \def\Xfoo#1{...}
501 % Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my
502 % favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03
504 \def\parseargdef#1{%
505 \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
507 \def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
508 \def#2{\parsearg#1}%
509 \def#1##1%
512 % Several utility definitions with active space:
514 \obeyspaces
515 \gdef\obeyedspace{ }
517 % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
518 % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
519 % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
520 % should produce a line of output anyway.
522 \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}
524 % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
525 % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
526 % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
527 \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space}
531 \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
533 % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
535 % \envdef\foo{...}
536 % \def\Efoo{...}
538 % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
539 % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
540 % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
541 % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
542 % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
544 % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
545 % are not treated as enviroments; they don't open a group. (The
546 % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
547 % special case.)
550 % At runtime, environments start with this:
551 \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
552 % initialize
553 \let\thisenv\empty
555 % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
556 \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
557 \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
559 % Check whether we're in the right environment:
560 \def\checkenv#1{%
561 \def\temp{#1}%
562 \ifx\thisenv\temp
563 \else
564 \badenverr
568 % Evironment mismatch, #1 expected:
569 \def\badenverr{%
570 \errhelp = \EMsimple
571 \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp,
572 not \inenvironment\thisenv}%
574 \def\inenvironment#1{%
575 \ifx#1\empty
576 out of any environment%
577 \else
578 in environment \expandafter\string#1%
582 % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
583 % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
585 \parseargdef\end{%
586 \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname
587 \else
588 % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal, but... --kasal, 06nov03
589 \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
590 \csname E#1\endcsname
591 \endgroup
595 \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
598 %% Simple single-character @ commands
600 % @@ prints an @
601 % Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr).
602 \def\@{{\tt\char64}}
604 % This is turned off because it was never documented
605 % and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures.
606 %% Define @` and @' to be the same as ` and '
607 %% but suppressing ligatures.
608 %\def\`{{`}}
609 %\def\'{{'}}
611 % Used to generate quoted braces.
612 \def\mylbrace {{\tt\char123}}
613 \def\myrbrace {{\tt\char125}}
614 \let\{=\mylbrace
615 \let\}=\myrbrace
616 \begingroup
617 % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices,
618 % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files.
619 \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other
620 \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2
621 \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other
622 !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]%
623 !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]%
624 !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]%
625 !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]%
626 !endgroup
628 % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
629 \let\comma = ,
631 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
632 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
633 \let\, = \c
634 \let\dotaccent = \.
635 \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
636 \let\tieaccent = \t
637 \let\ubaraccent = \b
638 \let\udotaccent = \d
640 % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
641 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
642 \def\questiondown{?`}
643 \def\exclamdown{!`}
644 \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}}
645 \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}}
647 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
648 \def\imacro{i}
649 \def\jmacro{j}
650 \def\dotless#1{%
651 \def\temp{#1}%
652 \ifx\temp\imacro \ptexi
653 \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \j
654 \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}%
655 \fi\fi
658 % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
659 % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
661 \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
663 % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
664 % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
665 % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
666 % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
667 % \scriptscriptstyle).
669 \def\LaTeX{%
670 L\kern-.36em
671 {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
672 \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize A}\vss}}%
673 \kern-.15em
674 \TeX
677 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
678 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
679 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
680 % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
681 % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
682 {\catcode`@ = 11
683 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
684 % if the definition is written into an index file.
685 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
686 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ }
689 % @: forces normal size whitespace following.
690 \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 }
692 % @* forces a line break.
693 \def\*{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
695 % @/ allows a line break.
696 \let\/=\allowbreak
698 % @. is an end-of-sentence period.
699 \def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
701 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
702 \def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
704 % @? is an end-of-sentence query.
705 \def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
707 % @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
709 \def\onword{on}
710 \def\offword{off}
712 \parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
713 \def\temp{#1}%
714 \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
715 \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
716 \else
717 \errhelp = \EMsimple
718 \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on/off}%
719 \fi\fi
722 % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
723 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
724 % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
725 \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
727 % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
728 % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
729 % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
730 % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
731 % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
732 % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
733 % the text is small, which looks bad.
735 % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
736 % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
737 % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
738 % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
739 % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
740 % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
742 \newbox\groupbox
743 \def\vfilllimit{0.7}
745 \envdef\group{%
746 \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else
747 \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp
748 \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}%
750 \startsavinginserts
752 \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup
753 % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
754 % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
755 % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
756 % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
757 % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
758 % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
759 \comment
762 % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
763 % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
764 % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
765 % above. But it's pretty close.
766 \def\Egroup{%
767 % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
768 % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
769 \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
770 \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth
771 \egroup % End the \vtop.
772 % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
773 \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
774 % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
775 \dimen2 = \pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal
776 % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
777 % group, force a page break.
778 \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2
779 \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight
780 \page
783 \box\groupbox
784 \prevdepth = \dimen1
785 \checkinserts
788 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
789 % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
791 \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
792 group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J%
793 where each line of input produces a line of output.}
795 % @need space-in-mils
796 % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
798 \newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in
800 % Old definition--didn't work.
801 %\parseargdef\need{\par %
802 %% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally
803 %% if the depth of the box does not fit.
804 %{\baselineskip=0pt%
805 %\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\nobreak
806 %\prevdepth=-1000pt
809 \parseargdef\need{%
810 % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
811 % paragraph.
812 \par
814 % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
815 \dimen0 = #1\mil
816 \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox
817 \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox
818 \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2
820 % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
821 % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
822 % And a page break here is fine.
823 \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
825 % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
826 % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
827 % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
828 % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
829 % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
831 % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
832 % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
833 % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
834 % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
835 % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
836 % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
837 % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
838 \penalty9999
840 % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
841 \kern -#1\mil
843 % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
844 \nobreak
848 % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
850 \let\br = \par
852 % @page forces the start of a new page.
854 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
856 % @exdent text....
857 % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
859 % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
860 % That's how much \exdent should take out.
861 \newskip\exdentamount
863 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
864 \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
866 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
867 \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
868 \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
870 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
871 % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
872 % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'.
874 \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm
875 \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
877 \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
878 \nobreak
879 \kern-\strutdepth
880 \vtop to \strutdepth{%
881 \baselineskip=\strutdepth
882 \vss
883 % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
884 % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
885 \ifx#1l%
886 \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
887 \else
888 \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
890 \null
893 \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l}
894 \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r}
896 % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
897 % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
898 % else use TEXT for both).
900 \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish}
901 \def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
902 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
903 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
904 \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
905 \def\righttext{#2}%
906 \else
907 \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
908 \def\righttext{#1}%
911 \ifodd\pageno
912 \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
913 \else
914 \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
916 \temp
919 % @include file insert text of that file as input.
921 \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
922 \def\includezzz#1{%
923 \pushthisfilestack
924 \def\thisfile{#1}%
926 \makevalueexpandable
927 \def\temp{\input #1 }%
928 \expandafter
929 }\temp
930 \popthisfilestack
932 \def\filenamecatcodes{%
933 \catcode`\\=\other
934 \catcode`~=\other
935 \catcode`^=\other
936 \catcode`_=\other
937 \catcode`|=\other
938 \catcode`<=\other
939 \catcode`>=\other
940 \catcode`+=\other
941 \catcode`-=\other
944 \def\pushthisfilestack{%
945 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
947 \def\pushthisfilestackX{%
948 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
950 \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
951 \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
954 \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
955 \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
956 the stack of filenames is empty.}}
958 \def\thisfile{}
960 % @center line
961 % outputs that line, centered.
963 \parseargdef\center{%
964 \ifhmode
965 \let\next\centerH
966 \else
967 \let\next\centerV
969 \next{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
971 \def\centerH#1{%
973 \hfil\break
974 \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
975 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
976 \line{#1}%
977 \break
980 \def\centerV#1{\line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}}
982 % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
984 \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
986 % @comment ...line which is ignored...
987 % @c is the same as @comment
988 % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
990 \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other%
991 \catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other%
992 \commentxxx}
993 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}}
995 \let\c=\comment
997 % @paragraphindent NCHARS
998 % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
999 % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
1000 % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
1002 \def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords
1003 \def\noneword{none}
1005 \parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
1006 \def\temp{#1}%
1007 \ifx\temp\asisword
1008 \else
1009 \ifx\temp\noneword
1010 \defaultparindent = 0pt
1011 \else
1012 \defaultparindent = #1em
1015 \parindent = \defaultparindent
1018 % @exampleindent NCHARS
1019 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
1020 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
1021 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
1022 \parseargdef\exampleindent{%
1023 \def\temp{#1}%
1024 \ifx\temp\asisword
1025 \else
1026 \ifx\temp\noneword
1027 \lispnarrowing = 0pt
1028 \else
1029 \lispnarrowing = #1em
1034 % @firstparagraphindent WORD
1035 % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
1036 % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
1037 % paragraphs.
1039 % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
1040 % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
1041 % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
1042 % By default, we suppress indentation.
1044 \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
1045 \def\insertword{insert}
1047 \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
1048 \def\temp{#1}%
1049 \ifx\temp\noneword
1050 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
1051 \else\ifx\temp\insertword
1052 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax
1053 \else
1054 \errhelp = \EMsimple
1055 \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}%
1056 \fi\fi
1059 % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
1060 % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
1062 % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
1063 % paragraph.
1065 \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
1066 \gdef\indent{%
1067 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1068 \indent
1070 \gdef\noindent{%
1071 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1072 \noindent
1074 \global\everypar = {%
1075 \kern -\parindent
1076 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1080 \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
1081 \global \let \indent = \ptexindent
1082 \global \let \noindent = \ptexnoindent
1083 \global \everypar = {}%
1087 % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
1089 \def\asis#1{#1}
1091 % @math outputs its argument in math mode.
1093 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
1094 % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
1095 % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
1096 % which is what @var uses.
1098 \catcode`\_ = \active
1099 \gdef\mathunderscore{%
1100 \catcode`\_=\active
1101 \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
1104 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character.
1105 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but
1106 % this is not advertised and we don't care. Texinfo does not
1107 % otherwise define @\.
1109 % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
1110 \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi}
1112 \def\math{%
1113 \tex
1114 \mathunderscore
1115 \let\\ = \mathbackslash
1116 \mathactive
1117 $\finishmath
1119 \def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
1121 % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
1122 % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
1123 % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
1126 \catcode`^ = \active
1127 \catcode`< = \active
1128 \catcode`> = \active
1129 \catcode`+ = \active
1130 \gdef\mathactive{%
1131 \let^ = \ptexhat
1132 \let< = \ptexless
1133 \let> = \ptexgtr
1134 \let+ = \ptexplus
1138 % @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above.
1139 \def\bullet{$\ptexbullet$}
1140 \def\minus{$-$}
1142 % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
1143 % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
1144 % typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
1145 % in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do
1146 % whichever is larger.
1148 \def\dots{%
1149 \leavevmode
1150 \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods
1151 \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em
1152 \dimen0 = \wd0
1153 \else
1154 \dimen0 = 1.5em
1156 \hbox to \dimen0{%
1157 \hskip 0pt plus.25fil
1158 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
1159 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
1160 .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil
1164 % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
1166 \def\enddots{%
1167 \dots
1168 \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor
1171 % @comma{} is so commas can be inserted into text without messing up
1172 % Texinfo's parsing.
1174 \let\comma = ,
1176 % @refill is a no-op.
1177 \let\refill=\relax
1179 % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
1180 % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
1181 % This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename).
1183 \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
1184 \let\novalidate = \linksfalse
1186 % @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file.
1187 % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input.
1188 % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo.
1189 \def\setfilename{%
1190 \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
1191 \iflinks
1192 \tryauxfile
1193 % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
1194 \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
1195 \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case.
1196 \openindices
1197 \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
1199 % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
1200 % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc.
1201 \openin 1 texinfo.cnf
1202 \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi
1203 \closein 1
1205 \comment % Ignore the actual filename.
1208 % Called from \setfilename.
1210 \def\openindices{%
1211 \newindex{cp}%
1212 \newcodeindex{fn}%
1213 \newcodeindex{vr}%
1214 \newcodeindex{tp}%
1215 \newcodeindex{ky}%
1216 \newcodeindex{pg}%
1219 % @bye.
1220 \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend}
1223 \message{pdf,}
1224 % adobe `portable' document format
1225 \newcount\tempnum
1226 \newcount\lnkcount
1227 \newtoks\filename
1228 \newcount\filenamelength
1229 \newcount\pgn
1230 \newtoks\toksA
1231 \newtoks\toksB
1232 \newtoks\toksC
1233 \newtoks\toksD
1234 \newbox\boxA
1235 \newcount\countA
1236 \newif\ifpdf
1237 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
1239 % when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
1240 % can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as \undefined,
1241 % borrowed from ifpdf.sty.
1242 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
1243 \else
1244 \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
1245 \else
1246 \ifcase\pdfoutput
1247 \else
1248 \pdftrue
1253 % PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
1254 % for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
1255 % double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
1256 % interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
1257 % http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html
1258 % (and related messages, the final outcome is that it is up to the TeX
1259 % user to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
1260 % that's what we do).
1262 % double active backslashes.
1264 {\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active
1265 @gdef@activebackslashdouble{%
1266 @catcode`@\=@active
1267 @let\=@doublebackslash}
1270 % To handle parens, we must adopt a different approach, since parens are
1271 % not active characters. hyperref.dtx (which has the same problem as
1272 % us) handles it with this amazing macro to replace tokens, with minor
1273 % changes for Texinfo. It is included here under the GPL by permission
1274 % from the author, Heiko Oberdiek.
1276 % #1 is the tokens to replace.
1277 % #2 is the replacement.
1278 % #3 is the control sequence with the string.
1280 \def\HyPsdSubst#1#2#3{%
1281 \def\HyPsdReplace##1#1##2\END{%
1282 ##1%
1283 \ifx\\##2\\%
1284 \else
1286 \HyReturnAfterFi{%
1287 \HyPsdReplace##2\END
1291 \xdef#3{\expandafter\HyPsdReplace#3#1\END}%
1293 \long\def\HyReturnAfterFi#1\fi{\fi#1}
1295 % #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements.
1296 \def\backslashparens#1{%
1297 \xdef#1{#1}% redefine it as its expansion; the definition is simply
1298 % \lastnode when called from \setref -> \pdfmkdest.
1299 \HyPsdSubst{(}{\realbackslash(}{#1}%
1300 \HyPsdSubst{)}{\realbackslash)}{#1}%
1303 \newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
1304 with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found. (.eps cannot
1305 be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
1306 output) for that.)}
1308 \ifpdf
1310 % Color manipulation macros based on pdfcolor.tex.
1311 \def\cmykDarkRed{0.28 1 1 0.35}
1312 \def\cmykBlack{0 0 0 1}
1314 \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 k}}
1315 % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
1316 % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
1317 \def\setcolor#1{%
1318 \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
1319 \domark
1320 \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
1323 \def\maincolor{\cmykBlack}
1324 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
1325 \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
1326 \def\lastcolordefs{}
1328 \def\makefootline{%
1329 \baselineskip24pt
1330 \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
1333 \def\makeheadline{%
1334 \vbox to 0pt{%
1335 \vskip-22.5pt
1336 \line{%
1337 \vbox to8.5pt{}%
1338 % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
1339 \getcolormarks
1340 % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
1341 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
1343 \vss
1345 \nointerlineskip
1349 \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}
1351 % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
1352 \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
1353 \def\imagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
1354 \def\imageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
1356 % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .png, .jpg, .pdf (among
1357 % others). Let's try in that order.
1358 \let\pdfimgext=\empty
1359 \begingroup
1360 \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
1361 \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
1362 \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
1363 \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
1364 \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
1365 \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp
1366 \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}%
1367 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}%
1369 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}%
1371 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}%
1373 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}%
1375 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}%
1377 \closein 1
1378 \endgroup
1380 % without \immediate, pdftex seg faults when the same image is
1381 % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
1382 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1383 \immediate\pdfimage
1384 \else
1385 \immediate\pdfximage
1387 \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \imagewidth \fi
1388 \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \imageheight \fi
1389 \ifnum\pdftexversion<13
1390 #1.\pdfimgext
1391 \else
1392 {#1.\pdfimgext}%
1394 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else
1395 \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
1396 \fi}
1398 \def\pdfmkdest#1{{%
1399 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
1400 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
1401 \indexnofonts
1402 \turnoffactive
1403 \activebackslashdouble
1404 \makevalueexpandable
1405 \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
1406 \backslashparens\pdfdestname
1407 \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
1410 % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
1411 \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}
1413 % by default, use a color that is dark enough to print on paper as
1414 % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing.
1415 \def\urlcolor{\cmykDarkRed}
1416 \def\linkcolor{\cmykDarkRed}
1417 \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
1419 % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
1420 % come from Petr Olsak
1421 \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
1422 \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
1423 \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax
1424 \advance\tempnum by 1
1425 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
1427 % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
1428 % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
1429 % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text,
1430 % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
1431 % #4 is the page number
1433 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
1434 % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
1435 % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
1436 % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
1437 % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
1438 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
1439 \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty
1440 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}%
1441 \else
1442 % Doubled backslashes in the name.
1443 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
1444 \backslashparens\pdfoutlinedest}%
1447 % Also double the backslashes in the display string.
1448 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1449 \backslashparens\pdfoutlinetext}%
1451 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
1454 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
1455 \begingroup
1456 % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks
1457 \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\{=\mylbrace
1458 \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\}=\myrbrace
1460 % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
1461 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1462 \def\thischapnum{##2}%
1463 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1464 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1466 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1467 \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}%
1468 \def\thissecnum{##2}%
1469 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1471 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1472 \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}%
1473 \def\thissubsecnum{##2}%
1475 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1476 \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}%
1478 \def\thischapnum{0}%
1479 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1480 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1482 % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
1483 % al. a second time, below.
1484 \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
1485 \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1486 \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1487 \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1488 \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
1489 \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1490 \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1491 \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1492 \readdatafile{toc}%
1494 % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
1495 % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
1496 % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
1498 % We use the node names as the destinations.
1499 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1500 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1501 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1502 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1503 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1504 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1505 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero
1506 \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}%
1508 % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
1509 % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
1510 % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
1511 % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
1512 % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
1514 % xx to do this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
1515 % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Right
1516 % now, I guess we'll just let the pdf reader have its way.
1517 \indexnofonts
1518 \setupdatafile
1519 \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
1520 \input \tocreadfilename
1521 \endgroup
1524 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
1525 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
1526 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
1527 \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
1528 \advance\filenamelength by 1
1531 \nextsp}
1532 \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|\relax}
1533 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1534 \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
1535 \else
1536 \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
1538 % make a live url in pdf output.
1539 \def\pdfurl#1{%
1540 \begingroup
1541 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
1542 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
1543 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
1544 % people have actually reported a problem with.
1546 \normalturnoffactive
1547 \def\@{@}%
1548 \let\/=\empty
1549 \makevalueexpandable
1550 \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
1551 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
1552 user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}%
1553 \endgroup}
1554 \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
1555 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
1556 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
1557 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
1558 \def\maketoks{%
1559 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
1560 \ifx\first0\adn0
1561 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
1562 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
1563 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
1564 \else
1565 \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
1566 \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
1567 \let\next=\maketoks
1568 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
1569 \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
1571 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
1572 \next}
1573 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
1574 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
1575 \def\pdflink#1{%
1576 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
1577 \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
1578 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
1579 \else
1580 \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
1581 \let\pdfurl = \gobble
1582 \let\endlink = \relax
1583 \let\setcolor = \gobble
1584 \let\pdfsetcolor = \gobble
1585 \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
1586 \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
1589 \message{fonts,}
1591 % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
1592 % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
1593 % italics, not bold italics.
1595 \def\setfontstyle#1{%
1596 \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
1597 \csname ten#1\endcsname % change the current font
1600 % Select #1 fonts with the current style.
1602 \def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname}
1604 \def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}}
1605 \def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}}
1606 \def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}}
1607 \def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf}
1608 \def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}}
1610 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
1611 % So we set up a \sf.
1612 \newfam\sffam
1613 \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}}
1614 \let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf.
1616 % We don't need math for this font style.
1617 \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}}
1620 % Default leading.
1621 \newdimen\textleading \textleading = 13.2pt
1623 % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
1624 % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
1625 % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
1627 \def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
1628 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
1629 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
1631 % can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this.
1632 \def\baselinefactor{1}
1634 \def\setleading#1{%
1635 \dimen0 = #1\relax
1636 \normalbaselineskip = \baselinefactor\dimen0
1637 \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
1638 \normalbaselines
1639 \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
1640 \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
1641 depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
1646 % PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
1648 % \cmapOT1
1649 \ifpdf
1650 \begingroup
1651 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1652 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1653 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1654 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1655 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
1656 %%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
1657 %%Version: 1.000
1658 %%EndComments
1659 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1660 12 dict begin
1661 begincmap
1662 /CIDSystemInfo
1663 << /Registry (TeX)
1664 /Ordering (OT1)
1665 /Supplement 0
1666 >> def
1667 /CMapName /TeX-OT1-0 def
1668 /CMapType 2 def
1669 1 begincodespacerange
1670 <00> <7F>
1671 endcodespacerange
1672 8 beginbfrange
1673 <00> <01> <0393>
1674 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1675 <23> <26> <0023>
1676 <28> <3B> <0028>
1677 <3F> <5B> <003F>
1678 <5D> <5E> <005D>
1679 <61> <7A> <0061>
1680 <7B> <7C> <2013>
1681 endbfrange
1682 40 beginbfchar
1683 <02> <0398>
1684 <03> <039B>
1685 <04> <039E>
1686 <05> <03A0>
1687 <06> <03A3>
1688 <07> <03D2>
1689 <08> <03A6>
1690 <0B> <00660066>
1691 <0C> <00660069>
1692 <0D> <0066006C>
1693 <0E> <006600660069>
1694 <0F> <00660066006C>
1695 <10> <0131>
1696 <11> <0237>
1697 <12> <0060>
1698 <13> <00B4>
1699 <14> <02C7>
1700 <15> <02D8>
1701 <16> <00AF>
1702 <17> <02DA>
1703 <18> <00B8>
1704 <19> <00DF>
1705 <1A> <00E6>
1706 <1B> <0153>
1707 <1C> <00F8>
1708 <1D> <00C6>
1709 <1E> <0152>
1710 <1F> <00D8>
1711 <21> <0021>
1712 <22> <201D>
1713 <27> <2019>
1714 <3C> <00A1>
1715 <3D> <003D>
1716 <3E> <00BF>
1717 <5C> <201C>
1718 <5F> <02D9>
1719 <60> <2018>
1720 <7D> <02DD>
1721 <7E> <007E>
1722 <7F> <00A8>
1723 endbfchar
1724 endcmap
1725 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1728 %%EndResource
1729 %%EOF
1730 }\endgroup
1731 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1\endcsname#1{%
1732 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1735 % \cmapOT1IT
1736 \begingroup
1737 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1738 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1739 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1740 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1741 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
1742 %%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
1743 %%Version: 1.000
1744 %%EndComments
1745 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1746 12 dict begin
1747 begincmap
1748 /CIDSystemInfo
1749 << /Registry (TeX)
1750 /Ordering (OT1IT)
1751 /Supplement 0
1752 >> def
1753 /CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-0 def
1754 /CMapType 2 def
1755 1 begincodespacerange
1756 <00> <7F>
1757 endcodespacerange
1758 8 beginbfrange
1759 <00> <01> <0393>
1760 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1761 <25> <26> <0025>
1762 <28> <3B> <0028>
1763 <3F> <5B> <003F>
1764 <5D> <5E> <005D>
1765 <61> <7A> <0061>
1766 <7B> <7C> <2013>
1767 endbfrange
1768 42 beginbfchar
1769 <02> <0398>
1770 <03> <039B>
1771 <04> <039E>
1772 <05> <03A0>
1773 <06> <03A3>
1774 <07> <03D2>
1775 <08> <03A6>
1776 <0B> <00660066>
1777 <0C> <00660069>
1778 <0D> <0066006C>
1779 <0E> <006600660069>
1780 <0F> <00660066006C>
1781 <10> <0131>
1782 <11> <0237>
1783 <12> <0060>
1784 <13> <00B4>
1785 <14> <02C7>
1786 <15> <02D8>
1787 <16> <00AF>
1788 <17> <02DA>
1789 <18> <00B8>
1790 <19> <00DF>
1791 <1A> <00E6>
1792 <1B> <0153>
1793 <1C> <00F8>
1794 <1D> <00C6>
1795 <1E> <0152>
1796 <1F> <00D8>
1797 <21> <0021>
1798 <22> <201D>
1799 <23> <0023>
1800 <24> <00A3>
1801 <27> <2019>
1802 <3C> <00A1>
1803 <3D> <003D>
1804 <3E> <00BF>
1805 <5C> <201C>
1806 <5F> <02D9>
1807 <60> <2018>
1808 <7D> <02DD>
1809 <7E> <007E>
1810 <7F> <00A8>
1811 endbfchar
1812 endcmap
1813 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1816 %%EndResource
1817 %%EOF
1818 }\endgroup
1819 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname#1{%
1820 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1823 % \cmapOT1TT
1824 \begingroup
1825 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1826 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1827 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1828 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1829 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
1830 %%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
1831 %%Version: 1.000
1832 %%EndComments
1833 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1834 12 dict begin
1835 begincmap
1836 /CIDSystemInfo
1837 << /Registry (TeX)
1838 /Ordering (OT1TT)
1839 /Supplement 0
1840 >> def
1841 /CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-0 def
1842 /CMapType 2 def
1843 1 begincodespacerange
1844 <00> <7F>
1845 endcodespacerange
1846 5 beginbfrange
1847 <00> <01> <0393>
1848 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1849 <21> <26> <0021>
1850 <28> <5F> <0028>
1851 <61> <7E> <0061>
1852 endbfrange
1853 32 beginbfchar
1854 <02> <0398>
1855 <03> <039B>
1856 <04> <039E>
1857 <05> <03A0>
1858 <06> <03A3>
1859 <07> <03D2>
1860 <08> <03A6>
1861 <0B> <2191>
1862 <0C> <2193>
1863 <0D> <0027>
1864 <0E> <00A1>
1865 <0F> <00BF>
1866 <10> <0131>
1867 <11> <0237>
1868 <12> <0060>
1869 <13> <00B4>
1870 <14> <02C7>
1871 <15> <02D8>
1872 <16> <00AF>
1873 <17> <02DA>
1874 <18> <00B8>
1875 <19> <00DF>
1876 <1A> <00E6>
1877 <1B> <0153>
1878 <1C> <00F8>
1879 <1D> <00C6>
1880 <1E> <0152>
1881 <1F> <00D8>
1882 <20> <2423>
1883 <27> <2019>
1884 <60> <2018>
1885 <7F> <00A8>
1886 endbfchar
1887 endcmap
1888 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1891 %%EndResource
1892 %%EOF
1893 }\endgroup
1894 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname#1{%
1895 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1897 \else
1898 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1\endcsname\gobble
1899 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname\gobble
1900 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname\gobble
1904 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the
1905 % specified font prefix (normally `cm').
1906 % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
1907 % encoding (currently only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, pass
1908 % empty to omit).
1909 \def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
1910 \font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4
1911 \csname cmap#5\endcsname#1%
1913 % This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
1914 \let\cmap\gobble
1917 % Use cm as the default font prefix.
1918 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
1919 % before you read in texinfo.tex.
1920 \ifx\fontprefix\undefined
1921 \def\fontprefix{cm}
1923 % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
1924 \def\rmshape{r}
1925 \def\rmbshape{bx} %where the normal face is bold
1926 \def\bfshape{b}
1927 \def\bxshape{bx}
1928 \def\ttshape{tt}
1929 \def\ttbshape{tt}
1930 \def\ttslshape{sltt}
1931 \def\itshape{ti}
1932 \def\itbshape{bxti}
1933 \def\slshape{sl}
1934 \def\slbshape{bxsl}
1935 \def\sfshape{ss}
1936 \def\sfbshape{ss}
1937 \def\scshape{csc}
1938 \def\scbshape{csc}
1940 % Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. This is the default in
1941 % Texinfo.
1943 \def\definetextfontsizexi{%
1944 % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
1945 \def\textnominalsize{11pt}
1946 \edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
1947 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1948 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
1949 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1950 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
1951 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1952 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1953 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1954 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
1955 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
1956 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
1957 \def\textecsize{1095}
1959 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
1960 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
1961 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
1962 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
1963 \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
1965 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
1966 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
1967 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1968 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
1969 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
1970 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
1971 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1972 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1973 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
1974 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
1975 \font\smalli=cmmi9
1976 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
1977 \def\smallecsize{0900}
1979 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
1980 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
1981 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1982 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
1983 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
1984 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
1985 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1986 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1987 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
1988 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
1989 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
1990 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
1991 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
1993 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
1994 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
1995 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
1996 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
1997 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
1998 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
1999 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
2000 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2001 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
2002 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2003 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
2004 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
2005 \def\authorrm{\secrm}
2006 \def\authortt{\sectt}
2007 \def\titleecsize{2074}
2009 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
2010 \def\chapnominalsize{17pt}
2011 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2012 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT}
2013 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2014 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2015 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
2016 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1}
2017 \let\chapbf=\chaprm
2018 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2019 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
2020 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
2021 \def\chapecsize{1728}
2023 % Section fonts (14.4pt).
2024 \def\secnominalsize{14pt}
2025 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2026 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
2027 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2028 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2029 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2030 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2031 \let\secbf\secrm
2032 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2033 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
2034 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
2035 \def\sececsize{1440}
2037 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
2038 \def\ssecnominalsize{13pt}
2039 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
2040 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT}
2041 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
2042 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2043 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT}
2044 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
2045 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
2046 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
2047 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
2048 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315
2049 \def\ssececsize{1200}
2051 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt).
2052 \def\reducednominalsize{10pt}
2053 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2054 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2055 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2056 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
2057 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2058 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2059 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2060 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2061 \font\reducedi=cmmi10
2062 \font\reducedsy=cmsy10
2063 \def\reducedecsize{1000}
2065 % reset the current fonts
2066 \textfonts
2068 } % end of 11pt text font size definitions
2071 % Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
2072 % section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU
2073 % Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the
2074 % future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
2076 \def\definetextfontsizex{%
2077 % Text fonts (10pt).
2078 \def\textnominalsize{10pt}
2079 \edef\mainmagstep{1000}
2080 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2081 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
2082 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2083 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
2084 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2085 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2086 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2087 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
2088 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
2089 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
2090 \def\textecsize{1000}
2092 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
2093 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
2094 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2095 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2096 \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
2098 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
2099 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
2100 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2101 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2102 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2103 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2104 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2105 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2106 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2107 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2108 \font\smalli=cmmi9
2109 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
2110 \def\smallecsize{0900}
2112 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
2113 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
2114 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2115 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
2116 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2117 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
2118 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2119 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2120 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2121 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
2122 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
2123 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
2124 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
2126 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
2127 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
2128 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2129 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
2130 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2131 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
2132 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
2133 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2134 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
2135 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2136 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
2137 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
2138 \def\authorrm{\secrm}
2139 \def\authortt{\sectt}
2140 \def\titleecsize{2074}
2142 % Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
2143 \def\chapnominalsize{14pt}
2144 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2145 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
2146 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2147 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2148 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2149 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2150 \let\chapbf\chaprm
2151 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2152 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
2153 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
2154 \def\chapecsize{1440}
2156 % Section fonts (12pt).
2157 \def\secnominalsize{12pt}
2158 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2159 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT}
2160 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2161 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
2162 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2163 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2164 \let\secbf\secrm
2165 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2166 \font\seci=cmmi12
2167 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1
2168 \def\sececsize{1200}
2170 % Subsection fonts (10pt).
2171 \def\ssecnominalsize{10pt}
2172 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2173 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
2174 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2175 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2176 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2177 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2178 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
2179 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2180 \font\sseci=cmmi10
2181 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10
2182 \def\ssececsize{1000}
2184 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (9pt).
2185 \def\reducednominalsize{9pt}
2186 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2187 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2188 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2189 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2190 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2191 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2192 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2193 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2194 \font\reducedi=cmmi9
2195 \font\reducedsy=cmsy9
2196 \def\reducedecsize{0900}
2198 % reduce space between paragraphs
2199 \divide\parskip by 2
2201 % reset the current fonts
2202 \textfonts
2204 } % end of 10pt text font size definitions
2207 % We provide the user-level command
2208 % @fonttextsize 10
2209 % (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed.
2211 \def\xword{10}
2212 \def\xiword{11}
2214 \parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
2215 \def\textsizearg{#1}%
2216 \wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}%
2218 % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
2219 % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
2221 \begingroup \globaldefs=1
2222 \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
2223 \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
2224 \else
2225 \errhelp=\EMsimple
2226 \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `10' or `11', not `\textsizearg'}
2227 \fi\fi
2228 \endgroup
2232 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
2233 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since
2234 % texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except
2235 % in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and
2236 % \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts).
2238 \def\resetmathfonts{%
2239 \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy
2240 \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf
2241 \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf
2244 % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead
2245 % of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the
2246 % current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire
2247 % \tenSTYLE to set the current font.
2249 % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
2250 % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used in
2251 % the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
2253 % This all needs generalizing, badly.
2255 \def\textfonts{%
2256 \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl
2257 \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc
2258 \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy
2259 \let\tenttsl=\textttsl
2260 \def\curfontsize{text}%
2261 \def\lsize{reduced}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2262 \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}}
2263 \def\titlefonts{%
2264 \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl
2265 \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc
2266 \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy
2267 \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl
2268 \def\curfontsize{title}%
2269 \def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}%
2270 \resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt}}
2271 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}}
2272 \def\chapfonts{%
2273 \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl
2274 \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc
2275 \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy
2276 \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl
2277 \def\curfontsize{chap}%
2278 \def\lsize{sec}\def\lllsize{text}%
2279 \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}}
2280 \def\secfonts{%
2281 \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl
2282 \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc
2283 \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy
2284 \let\tenttsl=\secttsl
2285 \def\curfontsize{sec}%
2286 \def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}%
2287 \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}}
2288 \def\subsecfonts{%
2289 \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl
2290 \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc
2291 \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy
2292 \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl
2293 \def\curfontsize{ssec}%
2294 \def\lsize{text}\def\lllsize{small}%
2295 \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}}
2296 \let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts
2297 \def\reducedfonts{%
2298 \let\tenrm=\reducedrm \let\tenit=\reducedit \let\tensl=\reducedsl
2299 \let\tenbf=\reducedbf \let\tentt=\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=\reducedsc
2300 \let\tensf=\reducedsf \let\teni=\reducedi \let\tensy=\reducedsy
2301 \let\tenttsl=\reducedttsl
2302 \def\curfontsize{reduced}%
2303 \def\lsize{small}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2304 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
2305 \def\smallfonts{%
2306 \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl
2307 \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc
2308 \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy
2309 \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl
2310 \def\curfontsize{small}%
2311 \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2312 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
2313 \def\smallerfonts{%
2314 \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl
2315 \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc
2316 \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy
2317 \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl
2318 \def\curfontsize{smaller}%
2319 \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2320 \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}}
2322 % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
2323 \let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts
2325 % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
2326 % can fit this many characters:
2327 % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
2328 % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
2329 % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
2330 % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
2331 % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
2333 % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
2334 % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
2336 % I wish the USA used A4 paper.
2337 % --karl, 24jan03.
2340 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
2342 \definetextfontsizexi
2344 % Define these so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
2345 \def\angleleft{$\langle$}
2346 \def\angleright{$\rangle$}
2348 % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
2349 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
2351 % Fonts for short table of contents.
2352 \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2353 \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} % no cmb12
2354 \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2355 \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
2357 %% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans
2358 %% serif) and @ii for TeX italic
2360 % \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction
2361 % unless the following character is such as not to need one.
2362 \def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else
2363 \ptexslash\fi\fi\fi}
2364 \def\smartslanted#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2365 \def\smartitalic#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2367 % like \smartslanted except unconditionally uses \ttsl.
2368 % @var is set to this for defun arguments.
2369 \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2371 % like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
2372 % ttsl for book titles, do we?
2373 \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2375 \let\i=\smartitalic
2376 \let\slanted=\smartslanted
2377 \let\var=\smartslanted
2378 \let\dfn=\smartslanted
2379 \let\emph=\smartitalic
2381 % @b, explicit bold.
2382 \def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
2383 \let\strong=\b
2385 % @sansserif, explicit sans.
2386 \def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
2388 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
2389 % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
2390 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
2392 \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
2393 \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- }
2395 % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
2396 % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
2397 % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
2399 \catcode`@=11
2400 \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
2401 \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m
2402 \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m
2403 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
2405 \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
2406 \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000
2407 \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250
2408 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
2410 \catcode`@=\other
2411 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
2413 \def\t#1{%
2414 {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2415 \null
2417 \def\samp#1{`\tclose{#1}'\null}
2418 \setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2419 \font\keysy=cmsy9
2420 \def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
2421 \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
2422 \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
2423 \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
2424 \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
2425 \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
2426 \def\key #1{{\nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
2427 % The old definition, with no lozenge:
2428 %\def\key #1{{\ttsl \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
2429 \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1}
2431 % @file, @option are the same as @samp.
2432 \let\file=\samp
2433 \let\option=\samp
2435 % @code is a modification of @t,
2436 % which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text.
2437 \def\tclose#1{%
2439 % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
2440 \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font
2442 % Switch to typewriter.
2445 % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
2446 \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}%
2448 % Turn off hyphenation.
2449 \nohyphenation
2451 \rawbackslash
2452 \plainfrenchspacing
2455 \null
2458 % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
2459 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
2460 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
2462 % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
2463 % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
2464 % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
2465 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash.
2466 % -- rms.
2468 \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
2469 \catcode`\'=\active \catcode`\`=\active
2471 \global\def\code{\begingroup
2472 \catcode\rquoteChar=\active \catcode\lquoteChar=\active
2473 \let'\codequoteright \let`\codequoteleft
2475 \catcode\dashChar=\active \catcode\underChar=\active
2476 \ifallowcodebreaks
2477 \let-\codedash
2478 \let_\codeunder
2479 \else
2480 \let-\realdash
2481 \let_\realunder
2483 \codex
2487 \def\realdash{-}
2488 \def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}}
2489 \def\codeunder{%
2490 % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
2491 % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
2492 % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
2493 % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
2494 \ifusingtt{\ifmmode
2495 \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
2496 \else\normalunderscore \fi
2497 \discretionary{}{}{}}%
2498 {\_}%
2500 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
2502 % An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
2503 % each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is undesirable in
2504 % some manuals, especially if they don't have long identifiers in
2505 % general. @allowcodebreaks provides a way to control this.
2507 \newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
2509 \def\keywordtrue{true}
2510 \def\keywordfalse{false}
2512 \parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
2513 \def\txiarg{#1}%
2514 \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
2515 \allowcodebreakstrue
2516 \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
2517 \allowcodebreaksfalse
2518 \else
2519 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2520 \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg'}%
2521 \fi\fi
2524 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
2525 % then @kbd has no effect.
2527 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
2528 % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
2529 % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
2530 \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
2531 \def\txiarg{#1}%
2532 \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
2533 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
2534 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
2535 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2536 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
2537 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2538 \else
2539 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2540 \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `\txiarg'}%
2541 \fi\fi\fi
2543 \def\worddistinct{distinct}
2544 \def\wordexample{example}
2545 \def\wordcode{code}
2547 % Default is `distinct.'
2548 \kbdinputstyle distinct
2550 \def\xkey{\key}
2551 \def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
2552 \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
2553 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi
2554 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi}
2556 % For @indicateurl, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code.
2557 \let\indicateurl=\code
2558 \let\env=\code
2559 \let\command=\code
2561 % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated)
2562 % second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third
2563 % arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url
2564 % itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. Perhaps eventually put in
2565 % a hypertex \special here.
2567 \def\uref#1{\douref #1,,,\finish}
2568 \def\douref#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{\begingroup
2569 \unsepspaces
2570 \pdfurl{#1}%
2571 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
2572 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
2573 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
2574 \else
2575 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
2576 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
2577 \ifpdf
2578 \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it
2579 \else
2580 \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url
2582 \else
2583 \code{#1}% only url given, so show it
2586 \endlink
2587 \endgroup}
2589 % @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
2591 \let\url=\uref
2593 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
2594 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
2596 %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
2597 \ifpdf
2598 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
2599 \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup
2600 \unsepspaces
2601 \pdfurl{mailto:#1}%
2602 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
2603 \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
2604 \endlink
2605 \endgroup}
2606 \else
2607 \let\email=\uref
2610 % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
2611 % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
2612 % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
2613 % this property, we can check that font parameter.
2615 \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt }
2617 % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
2618 % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
2620 \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
2622 \def\kbd#1{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??\par}
2624 % @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'',
2625 % and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for
2626 % Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96.
2627 %\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null}
2629 % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
2630 \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
2631 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
2632 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
2634 % @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
2635 % We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
2636 % all-uppercase.
2638 \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish}
2639 \def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{%
2640 {\selectfonts\lsize #1}%
2641 \def\temp{#2}%
2642 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2643 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
2647 % @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
2648 % No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
2650 \def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish}
2651 \def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{%
2652 {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2653 \def\temp{#2}%
2654 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2655 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
2659 % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
2661 \def\pounds{{\it\$}}
2663 % @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
2664 % We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
2665 % Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
2666 % "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
2667 % It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
2669 % Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
2670 % that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
2671 % font height.
2673 % feymr - regular
2674 % feymo - slanted
2675 % feybr - bold
2676 % feybo - bold slanted
2678 % There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
2679 % A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
2680 % Hmm.
2682 % Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
2683 % Hope not.
2686 \def\euro{{\eurofont e}}
2687 \def\eurofont{%
2688 % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
2689 % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
2690 % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
2691 % font installed.
2693 % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
2694 % that to the current nominal size.
2696 % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
2697 % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
2699 \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
2701 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
2702 % bold:
2703 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize
2704 \else
2705 % regular:
2706 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize
2708 \thiseurofont
2711 % Hacks for glyphs from the EC fonts similar to \euro. We don't
2712 % use \let for the aliases, because sometimes we redefine the original
2713 % macro, and the alias should reflect the redefinition.
2714 \def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"13}}
2715 \def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft}
2716 \def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"14}}
2717 \def\guillemotright{\guillemetright}
2718 \def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"0E}}
2719 \def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"0F}}
2720 \def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"12}}
2721 \def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"0D}}
2723 \def\ecfont{%
2724 % We can't distinguish serif/sanserif and italic/slanted, but this
2725 % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German
2726 % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so
2727 % hopefully nobody will notice/care.
2728 \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize\endcsname}%
2729 \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
2730 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
2731 % bold:
2732 \font\thisecfont = ecb\ifusingit{i}{x}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
2733 \else
2734 % regular:
2735 \font\thisecfont = ec\ifusingit{ti}{rm}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
2737 \thisecfont
2740 % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
2741 % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
2742 % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
2744 \def\registeredsymbol{%
2745 $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R}%
2746 \hfil\crcr\Orb}}%
2750 % @textdegree - the normal degrees sign.
2752 \def\textdegree{$^\circ$}
2754 % Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
2755 % Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
2756 % so we'll define it if necessary.
2758 \ifx\Orb\undefined
2759 \def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
2762 % Quotes.
2763 \chardef\quotedblleft="5C
2764 \chardef\quotedblright=`\"
2765 \chardef\quoteleft=`\`
2766 \chardef\quoteright=`\'
2768 \message{page headings,}
2770 \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in
2771 \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc
2773 % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
2774 \newif\ifseenauthor
2775 \newif\iffinishedtitlepage
2777 % Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the
2778 % user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage.
2780 \newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
2781 \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
2782 \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
2783 \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
2785 \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
2786 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
2788 \envdef\titlepage{%
2789 % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
2790 \begingroup
2791 \parindent=0pt \textfonts
2792 % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
2793 \vglue\titlepagetopglue
2794 % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
2795 \finishedtitlepagetrue
2797 % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
2798 % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
2799 \let\oldpage = \page
2800 \def\page{%
2801 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
2802 \finishtitlepage
2804 \let\page = \oldpage
2805 \page
2806 \null
2810 \def\Etitlepage{%
2811 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
2812 \finishtitlepage
2814 % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
2815 % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
2816 % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
2817 % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
2818 \oldpage
2819 \endgroup
2821 % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
2822 % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
2823 \HEADINGSon
2825 % If they want short, they certainly want long too.
2826 \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
2827 \shortcontents
2828 \contents
2829 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
2830 \global\let\contents = \relax
2833 \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
2834 \contents
2835 \global\let\contents = \relax
2836 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
2840 \def\finishtitlepage{%
2841 \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
2842 \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
2843 \finishedtitlepagetrue
2846 %%% Macros to be used within @titlepage:
2848 \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm
2849 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}
2851 \def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines
2852 \let\tt=\authortt}
2854 \parseargdef\title{%
2855 \checkenv\titlepage
2856 \leftline{\titlefonts\rm #1}
2857 % print a rule at the page bottom also.
2858 \finishedtitlepagefalse
2859 \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt
2862 \parseargdef\subtitle{%
2863 \checkenv\titlepage
2864 {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
2867 % @author should come last, but may come many times.
2868 % It can also be used inside @quotation.
2870 \parseargdef\author{%
2871 \def\temp{\quotation}%
2872 \ifx\thisenv\temp
2873 \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
2874 \else
2875 \checkenv\titlepage
2876 \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi
2877 {\authorfont \leftline{#1}}%
2882 %%% Set up page headings and footings.
2884 \let\thispage=\folio
2886 \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages
2887 \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages
2888 \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
2889 \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
2891 % Now make TeX use those variables
2892 \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
2893 \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
2894 \footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
2895 \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
2896 \let\HEADINGShook=\relax
2898 % Commands to set those variables.
2899 % For example, this is what @headings on does
2900 % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
2901 % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
2902 % @evenfooting @thisfile||
2903 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile
2906 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
2907 \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
2908 \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
2909 \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
2911 \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
2912 \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
2913 \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
2914 \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
2916 \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
2918 \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
2919 \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
2920 \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
2921 \global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
2923 \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
2924 \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
2925 \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
2926 \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
2928 % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
2929 % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
2930 \global\advance\pageheight by -12pt
2931 \global\advance\vsize by -12pt
2934 \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
2936 % @evenheadingmarks top \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page
2937 % @evenheadingmarks bottom \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page
2939 % The same set of arguments for:
2941 % @oddheadingmarks
2942 % @evenfootingmarks
2943 % @oddfootingmarks
2944 % @everyheadingmarks
2945 % @everyfootingmarks
2947 \def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}}
2948 \def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{heading}}
2949 \def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}}
2950 \def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{footing}}
2951 \def\everyheadingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{heading}{#1}
2952 \headingmarks{odd}{heading}{#1} }
2953 \def\everyfootingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{footing}{#1}
2954 \headingmarks{odd}{footing}{#1} }
2955 % #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom.
2956 \def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {%
2957 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get#3headingmarks\endcsname
2958 \global\expandafter\let\csname get#1#2marks\endcsname \temp
2961 \everyheadingmarks bottom
2962 \everyfootingmarks bottom
2964 % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
2965 % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
2966 % @headings off turns them off.
2967 % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
2968 % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
2969 % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
2970 % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
2971 % By default, they are off at the start of a document,
2972 % and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
2974 \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
2976 \def\HEADINGSoff{%
2977 \global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
2978 \global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}}
2979 \HEADINGSoff
2980 % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
2981 % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
2982 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
2983 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
2984 % edge of all pages.
2985 \def\HEADINGSdouble{%
2986 \global\pageno=1
2987 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
2988 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
2989 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
2990 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2991 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
2993 \let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
2995 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
2996 % page number on top right.
2997 \def\HEADINGSsingle{%
2998 \global\pageno=1
2999 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3000 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3001 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3002 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3003 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3005 \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
3007 \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex}
3008 \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter
3009 \def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
3010 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3011 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3012 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3013 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3014 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
3017 \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex}
3018 \def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
3019 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3020 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3021 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3022 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3023 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3026 % Subroutines used in generating headings
3027 % This produces Day Month Year style of output.
3028 % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
3029 % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
3030 \ifx\today\undefined
3031 \def\today{%
3032 \number\day\space
3033 \ifcase\month
3034 \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
3035 \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
3036 \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
3038 \space\number\year}
3041 % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
3042 % It generates no output of its own.
3043 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
3044 \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
3047 \message{tables,}
3048 % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
3050 % default indentation of table text
3051 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in
3052 % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
3053 \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in
3054 % margin between end of table item and start of table text.
3055 \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in
3057 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
3058 \newdimen\itemmax
3060 % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
3061 % these defs.
3062 % They also define \itemindex
3063 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
3065 \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
3067 \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi}
3069 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
3070 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
3072 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
3073 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
3074 \advance\hsize by -\tableindent
3075 \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
3076 \itemindex{#1}%
3077 \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
3079 % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
3080 % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
3081 % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
3082 % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
3083 % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
3084 \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax
3086 % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
3087 % but leave it ragged-right.
3088 \begingroup
3089 \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent
3090 \advance\hsize by\tableindent
3091 \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil
3092 \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
3093 \endgroup
3095 % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
3096 % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
3097 \nobreak \vskip-\parskip
3099 % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
3100 % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
3101 % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
3102 % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
3103 % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
3104 % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
3106 \penalty 10001
3107 \endgroup
3108 \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
3109 \else
3110 % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
3111 % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
3112 \noindent
3113 % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
3114 % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
3115 % eventually be printed.
3116 \nobreak\kern-\tableindent
3117 \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0
3118 \unhbox0
3119 \nobreak\kern\dimen0
3120 \endgroup
3121 \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
3125 \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}}
3126 \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}}
3128 % @table, @ftable, @vtable.
3129 \envdef\table{%
3130 \let\itemindex\gobble
3131 \tablecheck{table}%
3133 \envdef\ftable{%
3134 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}%
3135 \tablecheck{ftable}%
3137 \envdef\vtable{%
3138 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}%
3139 \tablecheck{vtable}%
3141 \def\tablecheck#1{%
3142 \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active
3143 \endgroup
3144 \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
3145 that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}%
3146 \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
3147 \else
3148 \let\next\tablex
3150 \next
3152 \def\tablex#1{%
3153 \def\itemindicate{#1}%
3154 \parsearg\tabley
3156 \def\tabley#1{%
3158 \makevalueexpandable
3159 \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
3160 \expandafter
3161 }\temp \endtablez
3163 \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
3164 \aboveenvbreak
3165 \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi
3166 \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi
3167 \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi
3168 \itemmax=\tableindent
3169 \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin
3170 \advance \leftskip by \tableindent
3171 \exdentamount=\tableindent
3172 \parindent = 0pt
3173 \parskip = \smallskipamount
3174 \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
3175 \let\item = \internalBitem
3176 \let\itemx = \internalBitemx
3178 \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
3179 \let\Eftable\Etable
3180 \let\Evtable\Etable
3181 \let\Eitemize\Etable
3182 \let\Eenumerate\Etable
3184 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
3186 \newcount \itemno
3188 \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
3190 \def\doitemize#1{%
3191 \aboveenvbreak
3192 \itemmax=\itemindent
3193 \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin
3194 \advance\leftskip by \itemindent
3195 \exdentamount=\itemindent
3196 \parindent=0pt
3197 \parskip=\smallskipamount
3198 \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
3199 \def\itemcontents{#1}%
3200 % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
3201 \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
3202 \let\item=\itemizeitem
3205 % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
3207 \def\itemizeitem{%
3208 \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations
3209 {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
3211 % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
3212 % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
3213 % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
3214 % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
3215 % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
3216 % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
3217 % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
3218 % that's the theory.
3219 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi
3220 \noindent
3221 \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
3222 \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item.
3223 \flushcr
3226 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
3227 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
3229 \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
3231 % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
3232 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
3233 % argument is the same as `1'.
3235 \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
3236 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
3237 % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
3238 \def\thearg{#1}%
3239 \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
3241 % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
3242 % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
3243 % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
3244 % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
3245 % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
3246 \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
3247 \ifx\rest\empty
3248 % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
3249 % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
3250 % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
3251 % not equal to itself.
3252 % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
3254 % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
3255 % continuing to look for a <number>.
3257 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax
3258 \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
3259 \else
3260 % It's a letter.
3261 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax
3262 \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
3263 \else
3264 \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
3267 \else
3268 % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
3269 \numericenumerate
3273 % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
3274 % given in \thearg.
3276 \def\numericenumerate{%
3277 \itemno = \thearg
3278 \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
3281 % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
3282 \def\lowercaseenumerate{%
3283 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
3284 \startenumeration{%
3285 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3286 \ifnum\itemno=0
3287 \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3288 alphabet}%
3290 \char\lccode\itemno
3294 % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
3295 \def\uppercaseenumerate{%
3296 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
3297 \startenumeration{%
3298 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3299 \ifnum\itemno=0
3300 \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3301 alphabet}
3303 \char\uccode\itemno
3307 % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
3308 % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
3309 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
3311 \def\startenumeration#1{%
3312 \advance\itemno by -1
3313 \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr
3316 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
3317 % to @enumerate.
3319 \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}}
3320 \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}}
3321 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3322 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3325 % @multitable macros
3326 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
3328 % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
3329 % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
3330 % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
3331 % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
3333 % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
3335 % To make preamble:
3337 % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
3338 % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
3339 % @item ...
3341 % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
3342 % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
3343 % columns as desired.
3346 % Or use a template:
3347 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3348 % @item ...
3349 % using the widest term desired in each column.
3351 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
3352 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
3353 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
3354 % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
3356 % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
3357 % if they are.
3359 % Sample multitable:
3361 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3362 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
3363 % @item
3364 % first col stuff
3365 % @tab
3366 % second col stuff
3367 % @tab
3368 % third col
3369 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
3370 % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
3372 % They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
3373 % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
3374 % @end multitable
3376 % Default dimensions may be reset by user.
3377 % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
3378 % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
3379 % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
3380 % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
3381 % to baseline.
3382 % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
3384 \newskip\multitableparskip
3385 \newskip\multitableparindent
3386 \newdimen\multitablecolspace
3387 \newskip\multitablelinespace
3388 \multitableparskip=0pt
3389 \multitableparindent=6pt
3390 \multitablecolspace=12pt
3391 \multitablelinespace=0pt
3393 % Macros used to set up halign preamble:
3395 \let\endsetuptable\relax
3396 \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
3397 \let\columnfractions\relax
3398 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
3399 \newif\ifsetpercent
3401 % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
3402 % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
3404 \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
3405 \global\advance\colcount by 1
3406 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
3407 \setuptable
3410 \newcount\colcount
3411 \def\setuptable#1{%
3412 \def\firstarg{#1}%
3413 \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
3414 \let\go = \relax
3415 \else
3416 \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
3417 \global\setpercenttrue
3418 \else
3419 \ifsetpercent
3420 \let\go\pickupwholefraction
3421 \else
3422 \global\advance\colcount by 1
3423 \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
3424 % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
3425 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
3428 \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
3429 % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
3430 % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
3431 \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
3432 \else
3433 \let\go = \setuptable
3434 \fi%
3439 % multitable-only commands.
3441 % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold.
3442 % Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group
3443 % of an alignment entry. Note that \everycr resets \everytab.
3444 \def\headitem{\checkenv\multitable \crcr \global\everytab={\bf}\the\everytab}%
3446 % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
3447 % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
3448 % we encounter the problem it was intended to solve again.
3449 % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
3450 \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}%
3452 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
3454 \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
3456 \envdef\multitable{%
3457 \vskip\parskip
3458 \startsavinginserts
3460 % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
3461 % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
3462 % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
3463 % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
3464 \def\item{\crcr}%
3466 \tolerance=9500
3467 \hbadness=9500
3468 \setmultitablespacing
3469 \parskip=\multitableparskip
3470 \parindent=\multitableparindent
3471 \overfullrule=0pt
3472 \global\colcount=0
3474 \everycr = {%
3475 \noalign{%
3476 \global\everytab={}%
3477 \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter.
3478 % Check for saved footnotes, etc.
3479 \checkinserts
3480 % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages.
3481 %\filbreak
3482 % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the
3483 % table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the
3484 % problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl.
3488 \parsearg\domultitable
3490 \def\domultitable#1{%
3491 % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
3492 \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
3494 % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
3495 % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
3496 % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
3497 % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
3498 \halign\bgroup &%
3499 \global\advance\colcount by 1
3500 \multistrut
3501 \vtop{%
3502 % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
3503 \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
3505 % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
3506 % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
3507 % the first one.
3509 % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
3510 % to the width of each template entry.
3512 % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
3513 % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
3514 % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
3515 % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
3517 % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
3518 \rightskip=0pt
3519 \ifnum\colcount=1
3520 % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
3521 \advance\hsize by\leftskip
3522 \else
3523 \ifsetpercent \else
3524 % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
3525 % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
3526 \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
3528 % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
3529 \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
3531 % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
3532 % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
3533 % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
3534 % For example:
3535 % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
3536 % @item @code{#}
3537 % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
3538 % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
3539 % marking characters.
3540 \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut
3541 }\cr
3543 \def\Emultitable{%
3544 \crcr
3545 \egroup % end the \halign
3546 \global\setpercentfalse
3549 \def\setmultitablespacing{%
3550 \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
3552 % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
3553 % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
3554 % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
3555 % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
3556 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt
3557 \setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip
3558 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0
3560 %% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
3561 %% table. If not, do nothing.
3562 %% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
3563 \ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace
3564 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
3565 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
3566 %% than skip between lines in the table.
3567 \fi%
3568 \ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt
3569 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
3570 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
3571 %% than skip between lines in the table.
3572 \fi}
3575 \message{conditionals,}
3577 % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
3578 % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
3579 % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
3580 % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
3581 % attempt to close an environment group.
3583 \def\makecond#1{%
3584 \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax
3585 \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1
3587 \makecond{iftex}
3588 \makecond{ifnotdocbook}
3589 \makecond{ifnothtml}
3590 \makecond{ifnotinfo}
3591 \makecond{ifnotplaintext}
3592 \makecond{ifnotxml}
3594 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
3596 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
3597 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}}
3598 \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}}
3599 \def\html{\doignore{html}}
3600 \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}}
3601 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
3602 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
3603 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}}
3604 \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}}
3605 \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}}
3606 \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}}
3607 \def\menu{\doignore{menu}}
3608 \def\xml{\doignore{xml}}
3610 % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
3612 % A count to remember the depth of nesting.
3613 \newcount\doignorecount
3615 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup
3616 % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
3617 \obeylines
3618 \catcode`\@ = \other
3619 \catcode`\{ = \other
3620 \catcode`\} = \other
3622 % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
3623 \spaceisspace
3625 % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
3626 \doignorecount = 0
3628 % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
3629 \dodoignore{#1}%
3632 { \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
3633 \obeylines %
3635 \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
3636 % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
3638 % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'.
3639 \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{%
3640 \doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}%
3642 % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
3643 % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
3644 % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
3645 \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}%
3647 % And now expand that command.
3648 \doignoretext ^^M%
3652 \def\doignoreyyy#1{%
3653 \def\temp{#1}%
3654 \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
3655 \let\next\doignoretextzzz
3656 \else % Found a nested condition, ...
3657 \advance\doignorecount by 1
3658 \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
3659 % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
3661 \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
3664 % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
3666 \def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
3667 \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
3668 \let\next\enddoignore
3669 \else % Still inside a nested condition.
3670 \advance\doignorecount by -1
3671 \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
3673 \next
3676 % Finish off ignored text.
3677 { \obeylines%
3678 % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim
3679 % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
3680 % would result in a blank line in the output.
3681 \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
3685 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
3686 % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
3688 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
3689 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
3690 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
3691 % didn't need it.
3692 % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
3694 \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
3695 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
3697 \makevalueexpandable
3698 \def\temp{#2}%
3699 \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}%
3700 \ifx\temp\empty
3701 \next{}%
3702 \else
3703 \setzzz#2\endsetzzz
3707 % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
3708 \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
3710 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
3712 \parseargdef\clear{%
3714 \makevalueexpandable
3715 \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax
3719 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
3720 \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
3721 \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
3723 \catcode`\- = \active \catcode`\_ = \active
3725 \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
3726 \let\value = \expandablevalue
3727 % We don't want these characters active, ...
3728 \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other
3729 % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
3730 % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
3731 % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
3732 \let-\realdash \let_\normalunderscore
3736 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
3737 % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
3738 % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
3739 % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the
3740 % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
3741 % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
3742 % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
3744 \def\expandablevalue#1{%
3745 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
3746 {[No value for ``#1'']}%
3747 \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}%
3748 \else
3749 \csname SET#1\endcsname
3753 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
3754 % with @set.
3756 % To get special treatment of `@end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine.
3758 \makecond{ifset}
3759 \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}}
3760 \def\doifset#1#2{%
3762 \makevalueexpandable
3763 \let\next=\empty
3764 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax
3765 #1% If not set, redefine \next.
3767 \expandafter
3768 }\next
3770 \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}}
3772 % @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been
3773 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
3775 % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
3776 % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
3777 % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
3779 \makecond{ifclear}
3780 \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}}
3781 \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}}
3783 % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
3784 % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
3785 \let\dircategory=\comment
3787 % @defininfoenclose.
3788 \let\definfoenclose=\comment
3791 \message{indexing,}
3792 % Index generation facilities
3794 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
3795 % except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
3796 \edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}}
3798 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo.
3799 % It automatically defines \fooindex such that
3800 % \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo.
3801 % It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for
3802 % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo.
3803 % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
3804 % for the sake of vms.
3806 \def\newindex#1{%
3807 \iflinks
3808 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
3809 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file
3811 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
3812 \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
3815 % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
3817 \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
3819 % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
3821 \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
3823 \def\newcodeindex#1{%
3824 \iflinks
3825 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
3826 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1
3828 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%
3829 \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
3833 % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
3834 % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
3836 % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
3837 % inside @code.
3839 \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
3840 \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
3842 % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
3843 % #3 the target index (bar).
3844 \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
3845 % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up
3846 % closing the target index.
3847 \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \undefined
3848 % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the
3849 % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files.
3850 \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname
3851 \expandafter\let\csname\donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1
3853 % redefine \fooindfile:
3854 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname
3855 \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp
3856 % redefine \fooindex:
3857 \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
3860 % Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros.
3861 % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
3862 % and it is "foo", the name of the index.
3864 % \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work.
3865 % This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros.
3867 % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
3868 % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
3870 \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer}
3871 \def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
3873 % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
3874 \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer}
3875 \def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
3877 % Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
3878 % Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't,
3879 % we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't.
3881 \def\indexdummies{%
3882 \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files.
3883 \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files.
3884 \def\ {\realbackslash\space }%
3886 % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
3887 % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
3888 % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters.
3889 \let\{ = \mylbrace
3890 \let\} = \myrbrace
3892 % I don't entirely understand this, but when an index entry is
3893 % generated from a macro call, the \endinput which \scanmacro inserts
3894 % causes processing to be prematurely terminated. This is,
3895 % apparently, because \indexsorttmp is fully expanded, and \endinput
3896 % is an expandable command. The redefinition below makes \endinput
3897 % disappear altogether for that purpose -- although logging shows that
3898 % processing continues to some further point. On the other hand, it
3899 % seems \endinput does not hurt in the printed index arg, since that
3900 % is still getting written without apparent harm.
3902 % Sample source (mac-idx3.tex, reported by Graham Percival to
3903 % help-texinfo, 22may06):
3904 % @macro funindex {WORD}
3905 % @findex xyz
3906 % @end macro
3907 % ...
3908 % @funindex commtest
3910 % The above is not enough to reproduce the bug, but it gives the flavor.
3912 % Sample whatsit resulting:
3913 % .@write3{\entry{xyz}{@folio }{@code {xyz@endinput }}}
3915 % So:
3916 \let\endinput = \empty
3918 % Do the redefinitions.
3919 \commondummies
3922 % For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character. So we want to
3923 % redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of
3924 % \realbackslash, still used for index files). When everything uses @,
3925 % this will be simpler.
3927 \def\atdummies{%
3928 \def\@{@@}%
3929 \def\ {@ }%
3930 \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd
3931 \let\} = \rbraceatcmd
3933 % Do the redefinitions.
3934 \commondummies
3935 \otherbackslash
3938 % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies.
3940 \def\commondummies{%
3942 % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
3943 % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control% words,
3944 % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
3945 % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
3946 % from whatever follows.
3948 % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
3949 % space.
3951 % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
3952 % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
3953 % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
3955 \def\definedummyword ##1{\def##1{\string##1\space}}%
3956 \def\definedummyletter##1{\def##1{\string##1}}%
3957 \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
3959 \commondummiesnofonts
3961 \definedummyletter\_%
3963 % Non-English letters.
3964 \definedummyword\AA
3965 \definedummyword\AE
3966 \definedummyword\L
3967 \definedummyword\OE
3968 \definedummyword\O
3969 \definedummyword\aa
3970 \definedummyword\ae
3971 \definedummyword\l
3972 \definedummyword\oe
3973 \definedummyword\o
3974 \definedummyword\ss
3975 \definedummyword\exclamdown
3976 \definedummyword\questiondown
3977 \definedummyword\ordf
3978 \definedummyword\ordm
3980 % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
3981 \definedummyword\bf
3982 \definedummyword\gtr
3983 \definedummyword\hat
3984 \definedummyword\less
3985 \definedummyword\sf
3986 \definedummyword\sl
3987 \definedummyword\tclose
3988 \definedummyword\tt
3990 \definedummyword\LaTeX
3991 \definedummyword\TeX
3993 % Assorted special characters.
3994 \definedummyword\bullet
3995 \definedummyword\comma
3996 \definedummyword\copyright
3997 \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
3998 \definedummyword\dots
3999 \definedummyword\enddots
4000 \definedummyword\equiv
4001 \definedummyword\error
4002 \definedummyword\euro
4003 \definedummyword\guillemetleft
4004 \definedummyword\guillemetright
4005 \definedummyword\guilsinglleft
4006 \definedummyword\guilsinglright
4007 \definedummyword\expansion
4008 \definedummyword\minus
4009 \definedummyword\pounds
4010 \definedummyword\point
4011 \definedummyword\print
4012 \definedummyword\quotedblbase
4013 \definedummyword\quotedblleft
4014 \definedummyword\quotedblright
4015 \definedummyword\quoteleft
4016 \definedummyword\quoteright
4017 \definedummyword\quotesinglbase
4018 \definedummyword\result
4019 \definedummyword\textdegree
4021 % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
4022 \macrolist
4024 \normalturnoffactive
4026 % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any
4027 % (non-fully-expandable) commands.
4028 \makevalueexpandable
4031 % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts.
4033 \def\commondummiesnofonts{%
4034 % Control letters and accents.
4035 \definedummyletter\!%
4036 \definedummyaccent\"%
4037 \definedummyaccent\'%
4038 \definedummyletter\*%
4039 \definedummyaccent\,%
4040 \definedummyletter\.%
4041 \definedummyletter\/%
4042 \definedummyletter\:%
4043 \definedummyaccent\=%
4044 \definedummyletter\?%
4045 \definedummyaccent\^%
4046 \definedummyaccent\`%
4047 \definedummyaccent\~%
4048 \definedummyword\u
4049 \definedummyword\v
4050 \definedummyword\H
4051 \definedummyword\dotaccent
4052 \definedummyword\ringaccent
4053 \definedummyword\tieaccent
4054 \definedummyword\ubaraccent
4055 \definedummyword\udotaccent
4056 \definedummyword\dotless
4058 % Texinfo font commands.
4059 \definedummyword\b
4060 \definedummyword\i
4061 \definedummyword\r
4062 \definedummyword\sc
4063 \definedummyword\t
4065 % Commands that take arguments.
4066 \definedummyword\acronym
4067 \definedummyword\cite
4068 \definedummyword\code
4069 \definedummyword\command
4070 \definedummyword\dfn
4071 \definedummyword\emph
4072 \definedummyword\env
4073 \definedummyword\file
4074 \definedummyword\kbd
4075 \definedummyword\key
4076 \definedummyword\math
4077 \definedummyword\option
4078 \definedummyword\pxref
4079 \definedummyword\ref
4080 \definedummyword\samp
4081 \definedummyword\strong
4082 \definedummyword\tie
4083 \definedummyword\uref
4084 \definedummyword\url
4085 \definedummyword\var
4086 \definedummyword\verb
4087 \definedummyword\w
4088 \definedummyword\xref
4091 % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
4092 % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
4093 % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
4094 % would be for a given command (usually its argument).
4096 \def\indexnofonts{%
4097 % Accent commands should become @asis.
4098 \def\definedummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}%
4099 % We can just ignore other control letters.
4100 \def\definedummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}%
4101 % Hopefully, all control words can become @asis.
4102 \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent
4104 \commondummiesnofonts
4106 % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
4107 % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
4108 % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
4109 %\let\tt=\asis
4111 \def\ { }%
4112 \def\@{@}%
4113 % how to handle braces?
4114 \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
4116 % Non-English letters.
4117 \def\AA{AA}%
4118 \def\AE{AE}%
4119 \def\L{L}%
4120 \def\OE{OE}%
4121 \def\O{O}%
4122 \def\aa{aa}%
4123 \def\ae{ae}%
4124 \def\l{l}%
4125 \def\oe{oe}%
4126 \def\o{o}%
4127 \def\ss{ss}%
4128 \def\exclamdown{!}%
4129 \def\questiondown{?}%
4130 \def\ordf{a}%
4131 \def\ordm{o}%
4133 \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}%
4134 \def\TeX{TeX}%
4136 % Assorted special characters.
4137 % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.)
4138 \def\bullet{bullet}%
4139 \def\comma{,}%
4140 \def\copyright{copyright}%
4141 \def\registeredsymbol{R}%
4142 \def\dots{...}%
4143 \def\enddots{...}%
4144 \def\equiv{==}%
4145 \def\error{error}%
4146 \def\euro{euro}%
4147 \def\guillemetleft{<<}%
4148 \def\guillemetright{>>}%
4149 \def\guilsinglleft{<}%
4150 \def\guilsinglright{>}%
4151 \def\expansion{==>}%
4152 \def\minus{-}%
4153 \def\pounds{pounds}%
4154 \def\point{.}%
4155 \def\print{-|}%
4156 \def\quotedblbase{"}%
4157 \def\quotedblleft{"}%
4158 \def\quotedblright{"}%
4159 \def\quoteleft{`}%
4160 \def\quoteright{'}%
4161 \def\quotesinglbase{,}%
4162 \def\result{=>}%
4163 \def\textdegree{degrees}%
4165 % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
4166 % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
4167 % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
4168 % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
4169 % that starts with \.
4171 % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
4172 % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
4173 % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
4175 \macrolist
4178 \let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex.
4179 \let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
4181 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
4182 % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
4183 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
4185 % Workhorse for all \fooindexes.
4186 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
4187 % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
4188 % is with most defuns, which call us directly).
4190 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
4191 \iflinks
4193 % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
4194 \toks0 = {#2}%
4195 % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
4196 \def\thirdarg{#3}%
4197 \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
4198 \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
4201 \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
4203 \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite
4208 % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file:
4210 \def\dosubindwrite{%
4211 % Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
4212 \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
4213 \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}%
4216 % Remember, we are within a group.
4217 \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
4218 \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
4219 % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash.
4221 % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to
4222 % get the string to sort by.
4223 {\indexnofonts
4224 \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion
4225 \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}%
4228 % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
4229 % the original text, including any font commands. We write
4230 % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
4231 % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
4232 % sorted result.
4233 \edef\temp{%
4234 \write\writeto{%
4235 \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
4237 \temp
4240 % Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
4242 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
4243 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
4244 % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
4245 % \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that
4246 % sequences like this:
4247 % @end defun
4248 % @tindex whatever
4249 % @defun ...
4250 % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
4251 % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
4252 % the previous defun.
4254 % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
4255 % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
4257 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
4259 % But wait, there is a catch there:
4260 % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
4261 % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
4262 % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
4263 % representation of the skip.
4265 % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
4266 % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
4268 \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname}
4270 \newskip\whatsitskip
4271 \newcount\whatsitpenalty
4273 % ..., ready, GO:
4275 \def\safewhatsit#1{%
4276 \ifhmode
4278 \else
4279 % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
4280 \whatsitskip = \lastskip
4281 \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
4282 \whatsitpenalty = \lastpenalty
4284 % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
4285 % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
4286 % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a
4287 % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
4288 % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
4289 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
4290 \else
4291 \vskip-\whatsitskip
4296 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
4297 % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
4298 % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
4299 % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
4300 % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
4301 % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
4303 % @deffn deffn-whatever
4304 % @vindex index-whatever
4305 % Description.
4306 % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
4307 % and the "Description." paragraph.
4308 \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
4309 \else
4310 % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
4311 % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
4312 % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
4313 \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
4318 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like
4319 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
4320 % or
4321 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
4322 % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
4323 % containing these kinds of lines:
4324 % \initial {c}
4325 % before the first topic whose initial is c
4326 % \entry {topic}{pagelist}
4327 % for a topic that is used without subtopics
4328 % \primary {topic}
4329 % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
4330 % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
4331 % for each subtopic.
4333 % Define the user-accessible indexing commands
4334 % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
4336 \def\findex {\fnindex}
4337 \def\kindex {\kyindex}
4338 \def\cindex {\cpindex}
4339 \def\vindex {\vrindex}
4340 \def\tindex {\tpindex}
4341 \def\pindex {\pgindex}
4343 \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub}
4344 {\obeylines %
4345 \gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup %
4346 \dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}}
4348 % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
4350 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
4351 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
4353 \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
4354 \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
4356 \smallfonts \rm
4357 \tolerance = 9500
4358 \plainfrenchspacing
4359 \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
4361 % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
4362 % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
4363 % \initial {@}
4364 % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces
4365 % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence).
4366 \catcode`\@ = 11
4367 \openin 1 \jobname.#1s
4368 \ifeof 1
4369 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
4370 % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
4371 % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
4372 % there is some text.
4373 \putwordIndexNonexistent
4374 \else
4376 % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
4377 % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
4378 % it can discover if there is anything in it.
4379 \read 1 to \temp
4380 \ifeof 1
4381 \putwordIndexIsEmpty
4382 \else
4383 % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
4384 % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
4385 % to make right now.
4386 \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}%
4387 \catcode`\\ = 0
4388 \escapechar = `\\
4389 \begindoublecolumns
4390 \input \jobname.#1s
4391 \enddoublecolumns
4394 \closein 1
4395 \endgroup}
4397 % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
4398 % Change them to control the appearance of the index.
4400 \def\initial#1{{%
4401 % Some minor font changes for the special characters.
4402 \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt
4404 % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
4405 \removelastskip
4407 % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
4408 \nobreak
4409 \vskip 0pt plus 3\baselineskip
4410 \penalty 0
4411 \vskip 0pt plus -3\baselineskip
4413 % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
4414 % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
4415 % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
4416 % we need before each entry, but it's better.
4418 % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
4419 \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip
4420 \leftline{\secbf #1}%
4421 % Do our best not to break after the initial.
4422 \nobreak
4423 \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
4426 % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
4427 % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
4428 % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
4430 % A straightforward implementation would start like this:
4431 % \def\entry#1#2{...
4432 % But this frozes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to
4433 % @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge---
4434 % ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right.
4436 % The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text.
4437 % --kasal, 21nov03
4438 \def\entry{%
4439 \begingroup
4441 % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
4442 % affect previous text.
4443 \par
4445 % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
4446 \parfillskip = 0in
4448 % No extra space above this paragraph.
4449 \parskip = 0in
4451 % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
4452 \finalhyphendemerits = 0
4454 % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
4455 % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the
4456 % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large
4457 % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
4458 % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
4460 % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
4461 % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
4462 \hangindent = 2em
4464 % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
4465 % with blank space.
4466 \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil
4468 % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing
4469 % columns.
4470 \vskip 0pt plus1pt
4472 % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
4473 \afterassignment\doentry
4474 \let\temp =
4476 \def\doentry{%
4477 \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
4478 \noindent
4479 \aftergroup\finishentry
4480 % And now comes the text of the entry.
4482 \def\finishentry#1{%
4483 % #1 is the page number.
4485 % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if
4486 % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be
4487 % cursed by a Unix daemon.
4488 \setbox\boxA = \hbox{#1}%
4489 \ifdim\wd\boxA = 0pt
4491 \else
4493 % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
4494 % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
4495 % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
4496 \hfil\penalty50
4497 \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
4499 % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
4500 % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull
4501 % \hbox ensues.
4502 \ifpdf
4503 \pdfgettoks#1.%
4504 \ \the\toksA
4505 \else
4506 \ #1%
4509 \par
4510 \endgroup
4513 % Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
4514 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
4515 \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill}
4517 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
4519 \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm
4520 \def\secondary#1#2{{%
4521 \parfillskip=0in
4522 \parskip=0in
4523 \hangindent=1in
4524 \hangafter=1
4525 \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill
4526 \ifpdf
4527 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
4528 \else
4531 \par
4534 % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
4535 % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
4536 % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
4537 \catcode`\@=11
4539 \newbox\partialpage
4540 \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
4542 \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
4543 % Grab any single-column material above us.
4544 \output = {%
4546 % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a
4547 % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output
4548 % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is
4549 % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In
4550 % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal
4551 % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this
4552 % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case.
4553 \ifvoid\partialpage \else
4554 \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}%
4557 \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{%
4558 % Unvbox the main output page.
4559 \unvbox\PAGE
4560 \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip
4563 \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
4565 % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
4566 \output = {\doublecolumnout}%
4568 % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
4569 % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
4570 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
4571 % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
4572 % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
4574 % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
4575 % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
4576 % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
4577 % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
4578 % as it did when we hard-coded it.
4580 % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
4581 % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
4582 % been clobbered.
4584 \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize
4585 \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize
4586 \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2
4587 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
4589 % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here,
4590 % since nobody clobbers \vsize.)
4591 \vsize = 2\vsize
4594 % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
4595 % the last.
4597 \def\doublecolumnout{%
4598 \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth
4599 % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
4600 % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
4601 % previous page.
4602 \dimen@ = \vsize
4603 \divide\dimen@ by 2
4604 \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage
4606 % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
4607 \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@
4608 \onepageout\pagesofar
4609 \unvbox255
4610 \penalty\outputpenalty
4613 % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
4614 % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
4615 \def\pagesofar{%
4616 \unvbox\partialpage
4618 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
4619 \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize
4620 \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
4623 % All done with double columns.
4624 \def\enddoublecolumns{%
4625 % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
4626 % _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the
4627 % following situation:
4629 % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry.
4630 % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no
4631 % break occurs before the last section starts. However, the last
4632 % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not
4633 % fit on the page and has to be broken off. Without the following
4634 % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject
4635 % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output
4636 % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last
4637 % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which
4638 % is wrong: The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with
4639 % the broken-off section in the recent contributions. As soon as
4640 % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page
4641 % break. The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the
4642 % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page
4643 % goal. When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final
4644 % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after
4645 % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns
4646 % and the final section into the vbox of \pageheight (see
4647 % \pagebody), causing an overfull box.
4649 % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the
4650 % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281).
4651 \penalty0
4653 \output = {%
4654 % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the
4655 % current page, no automatic page break.
4656 \balancecolumns
4658 % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page,
4659 % though, there will be another page break right after this \output
4660 % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
4661 % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
4662 % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be
4663 % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes
4664 % the output somewhat more palatable.)
4665 \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}%
4667 \eject
4668 \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
4670 % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
4671 % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
4672 % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the
4673 % \endgroup where \vsize got restored).
4674 \pagegoal = \vsize
4677 % Called at the end of the double column material.
4678 \def\balancecolumns{%
4679 \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
4680 \dimen@ = \ht0
4681 \advance\dimen@ by \topskip
4682 \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip
4683 \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to
4684 %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}%
4685 \splittopskip = \topskip
4686 % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint.
4688 \vbadness = 10000
4689 \loop
4690 \global\setbox3 = \copy0
4691 \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@
4692 \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@
4693 \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt
4694 \repeat
4696 %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}%
4697 \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}%
4698 \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}%
4700 \pagesofar
4702 \catcode`\@ = \other
4705 \message{sectioning,}
4706 % Chapters, sections, etc.
4708 % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron, of course. But we count the unnumbered
4709 % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
4710 % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
4711 % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
4712 % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
4713 \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000
4714 \newcount\chapno
4715 \newcount\secno \secno=0
4716 \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0
4717 \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0
4719 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
4720 \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
4722 % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
4723 % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
4724 % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
4725 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
4727 \def\appendixletter{%
4728 \ifnum\appendixno=`A A%
4729 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B%
4730 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C%
4731 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D%
4732 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E%
4733 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F%
4734 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G%
4735 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H%
4736 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I%
4737 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J%
4738 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K%
4739 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L%
4740 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M%
4741 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N%
4742 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O%
4743 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P%
4744 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q%
4745 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R%
4746 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S%
4747 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T%
4748 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U%
4749 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V%
4750 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W%
4751 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X%
4752 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y%
4753 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z%
4754 % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
4755 % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not
4756 % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
4757 % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
4758 \else\char\the\appendixno
4759 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
4760 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
4762 % Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number
4763 % and name of the chapter. Page headings and footings can use
4764 % these. @section does likewise.
4765 \def\thischapter{}
4766 \def\thischapternum{}
4767 \def\thischaptername{}
4768 \def\thissection{}
4769 \def\thissectionnum{}
4770 \def\thissectionname{}
4772 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
4773 \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
4775 % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
4776 \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1}
4777 \let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name
4779 % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
4780 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1}
4781 \let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name
4783 % we only have subsub.
4784 \chardef\maxseclevel = 3
4786 % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
4787 % To achive this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
4788 \chardef\unmlevel = \maxseclevel
4790 % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
4791 % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
4792 \def\chapheadtype{N}
4794 % Choose a heading macro
4795 % #1 is heading type
4796 % #2 is heading level
4797 % #3 is text for heading
4798 \def\genhead#1#2#3{%
4799 % Compute the abs. sec. level:
4800 \absseclevel=#2
4801 \advance\absseclevel by \secbase
4802 % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
4803 \ifnum \absseclevel < 0
4804 \absseclevel = 0
4805 \else
4806 \ifnum \absseclevel > 3
4807 \absseclevel = 3
4810 % The heading type:
4811 \def\headtype{#1}%
4812 \if \headtype U%
4813 \ifnum \absseclevel < \unmlevel
4814 \chardef\unmlevel = \absseclevel
4816 \else
4817 % Check for appendix sections:
4818 \ifnum \absseclevel = 0
4819 \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
4820 \else
4821 \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N%
4822 \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}%
4823 \fi\fi
4825 % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
4826 \ifnum \absseclevel > \unmlevel
4827 \def\headtype{U}%
4828 \else
4829 \chardef\unmlevel = 3
4832 % Now print the heading:
4833 \if \headtype U%
4834 \ifcase\absseclevel
4835 \unnumberedzzz{#3}%
4836 \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
4837 \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
4838 \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
4840 \else
4841 \if \headtype A%
4842 \ifcase\absseclevel
4843 \appendixzzz{#3}%
4844 \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
4845 \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
4846 \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
4848 \else
4849 \ifcase\absseclevel
4850 \chapterzzz{#3}%
4851 \or \seczzz{#3}%
4852 \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
4853 \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
4857 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
4860 % an interface:
4861 \def\numhead{\genhead N}
4862 \def\apphead{\genhead A}
4863 \def\unnmhead{\genhead U}
4865 % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
4866 % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
4868 % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
4869 % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
4870 \let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
4872 \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
4873 \def\chapterzzz#1{%
4874 % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
4875 % as an @include file.
4876 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
4877 \global\advance\chapno by 1
4879 % Used for \float.
4880 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}%
4881 \resetallfloatnos
4883 \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}%
4885 % Write the actual heading.
4886 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}%
4888 % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
4889 \global\let\section = \numberedsec
4890 \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
4891 \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
4894 \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz
4895 \def\appendixzzz#1{%
4896 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
4897 \global\advance\appendixno by 1
4898 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}%
4899 \resetallfloatnos
4901 \def\appendixnum{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}%
4902 \message{\appendixnum}%
4904 \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}%
4906 \global\let\section = \appendixsec
4907 \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
4908 \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
4911 \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz
4912 \def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
4913 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
4914 \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1
4916 % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
4917 \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
4918 \resetallfloatnos
4920 % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
4921 % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
4922 % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
4923 % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
4924 % to be executed, not expanded).
4926 % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
4927 % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
4928 % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
4929 % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
4930 % the toc entries.)
4931 \toks0 = {#1}%
4932 \message{(\the\toks0)}%
4934 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}%
4936 \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec
4937 \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec
4938 \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
4941 % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
4942 \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
4943 % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break
4944 % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level.
4945 % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04
4946 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters
4947 \unnmhead0{#1}%
4948 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
4951 % @top is like @unnumbered.
4952 \let\top\unnumbered
4954 % Sections.
4955 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
4956 \def\seczzz#1{%
4957 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
4958 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%
4961 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz
4962 \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
4963 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
4964 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%
4966 \let\appendixsec\appendixsection
4968 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz
4969 \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
4970 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
4971 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%
4974 % Subsections.
4975 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz
4976 \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
4977 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
4978 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
4981 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz
4982 \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
4983 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
4984 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%
4985 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
4988 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz
4989 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
4990 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
4991 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%
4992 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
4995 % Subsubsections.
4996 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz
4997 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
4998 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
4999 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%
5000 {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
5003 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz
5004 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
5005 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
5006 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%
5007 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
5010 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz
5011 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
5012 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
5013 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%
5014 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
5017 % These macros control what the section commands do, according
5018 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
5019 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
5020 \let\section = \numberedsec
5021 \let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
5022 \let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
5024 % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
5026 % NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such:
5027 % 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit
5028 % overlong headings to fold.
5029 % 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a
5030 % heading is obnoxious; this forbids it.
5031 % 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and
5032 % if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright.
5035 \def\majorheading{%
5036 {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
5037 \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
5040 \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
5041 \def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
5042 {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
5043 \parindent=0pt\raggedright
5044 \rm #1\hfill}}%
5045 \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax
5046 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
5049 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
5050 \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
5051 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5052 \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
5053 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5054 \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
5055 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5057 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
5058 % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
5059 % given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
5061 %%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
5062 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
5064 %%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it
5065 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
5067 \newskip\chapheadingskip
5069 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
5070 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
5071 % Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will
5072 % get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong. But we don't
5073 % care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page.
5074 \def\chapoddpage{%
5075 \chappager
5076 \ifodd\pageno \else
5077 \begingroup
5078 \evenheadline={\hfil}\evenfootline={\hfil}%
5079 \oddheadline={\hfil}\oddfootline={\hfil}%
5080 \hbox to 0pt{}%
5081 \chappager
5082 \endgroup
5086 \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
5088 \def\CHAPPAGoff{%
5089 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
5090 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak
5091 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager}
5093 \def\CHAPPAGon{%
5094 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
5095 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager
5096 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager
5097 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
5099 \def\CHAPPAGodd{%
5100 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
5101 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage
5102 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage
5103 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
5105 \CHAPPAGon
5107 % Chapter opening.
5109 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
5110 % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
5112 % To test against our argument.
5113 \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing}
5114 \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
5115 \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix}
5117 \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
5118 % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
5119 \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
5120 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
5121 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
5122 \gdef\thissection{}}%
5124 \def\temptype{#2}%
5125 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5126 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
5127 \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}%
5128 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5129 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
5130 \gdef\thischapter{}}%
5131 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5132 \toks0={#1}%
5133 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
5134 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
5135 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
5136 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \noexpand\thischapternum:
5137 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
5139 \else
5140 \toks0={#1}%
5141 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
5142 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
5143 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
5144 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \noexpand\thischapternum:
5145 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
5147 \fi\fi\fi
5149 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
5150 % the preceding space.
5151 \safewhatsit\domark
5153 % Insert the chapter heading break.
5154 \pchapsepmacro
5156 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
5157 % between here and the heading.
5158 \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
5159 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
5160 \domark
5163 \chapfonts \rm
5165 % Have to define \lastsection before calling \donoderef, because the
5166 % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
5167 % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
5168 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5170 % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
5171 % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
5172 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5173 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
5174 \def\toctype{unnchap}%
5175 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5176 \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
5177 \def\toctype{omit}%
5178 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5179 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
5180 \def\toctype{app}%
5181 \else
5182 \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}%
5183 \def\toctype{numchap}%
5184 \fi\fi\fi
5186 % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
5187 % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
5188 % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
5189 \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
5191 % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
5192 % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
5193 % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
5194 % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
5195 % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
5196 \donoderef{#2}%
5198 % Typeset the actual heading.
5199 \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue.
5200 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
5201 \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
5202 \unhbox0 #1\par}%
5204 \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
5205 \nobreak
5208 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
5209 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
5210 \def\centerparameters{%
5211 \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
5212 \leftskip = \rightskip
5213 \parfillskip = 0pt
5217 % I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not
5218 % updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03.
5220 \def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname}
5222 \def\unnchfopen #1{%
5223 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
5224 \parindent=0pt\raggedright
5225 \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
5227 \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts
5228 \vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}%
5229 \par\penalty 5000 %
5231 \def\centerchfopen #1{%
5232 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
5233 \parindent=0pt
5234 \hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
5236 \def\CHAPFopen{%
5237 \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen
5238 \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen}
5241 % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
5242 % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
5244 \newskip\secheadingskip
5245 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}}
5247 % Subsection titles.
5248 \newskip\subsecheadingskip
5249 \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}}
5251 % Subsubsection titles.
5252 \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
5253 \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
5256 % Print any size, any type, section title.
5258 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is
5259 % the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the
5260 % section number.
5262 \def\seckeyword{sec}
5264 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
5266 % Switch to the right set of fonts.
5267 \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rm
5269 \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
5270 \def\temptype{#3}%
5272 % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
5273 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
5274 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5275 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5276 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
5277 \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}%
5279 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5280 % Don't redefine \thissection.
5281 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5282 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5283 \toks0={#1}%
5284 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
5285 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
5286 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
5287 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\putwordSection{} \noexpand\thissectionnum:
5288 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
5291 \else
5292 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5293 \toks0={#1}%
5294 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
5295 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
5296 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
5297 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\putwordSection{} \noexpand\thissectionnum:
5298 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
5301 \fi\fi\fi
5303 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
5304 % the preceding space.
5305 \safewhatsit\domark
5307 % Insert space above the heading.
5308 \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname
5310 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
5311 % between here and the heading.
5312 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
5313 \domark
5315 % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
5316 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5317 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
5318 \def\toctype{unn}%
5319 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5320 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5321 % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
5322 % and don't redefine \lastsection.
5323 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
5324 \def\toctype{omit}%
5325 \let\sectionlevel=\empty
5326 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5327 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
5328 \def\toctype{app}%
5329 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5330 \else
5331 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
5332 \def\toctype{num}%
5333 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5334 \fi\fi\fi
5336 % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro.
5337 \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
5339 % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
5340 % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
5341 \donoderef{#3}%
5343 % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
5344 % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
5345 % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
5346 % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that
5347 % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
5348 % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000.
5349 \nobreak
5351 % Output the actual section heading.
5352 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
5353 \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number
5354 \unhbox0 #1}%
5356 % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
5357 % Don't allow stretch, though.
5358 \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname
5360 % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
5361 % was followed by glue.
5362 \nobreak
5364 % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
5365 % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
5366 % discardable item.)
5367 \vskip-\parskip
5369 % This is purely so the last item on the list is a known \penalty >
5370 % 10000. This is so \startdefun can avoid allowing breakpoints after
5371 % section headings. Otherwise, it would insert a valid breakpoint between:
5373 % @section sec-whatever
5374 % @deffn def-whatever
5375 \penalty 10001
5379 \message{toc,}
5380 % Table of contents.
5381 \newwrite\tocfile
5383 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
5384 % Called from @chapter, etc.
5386 % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
5387 % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
5388 % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
5389 % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
5390 % destination to jump to.
5392 % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
5393 % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
5394 % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
5395 % table of contents chapter openings themselves.
5397 \newif\iftocfileopened
5398 \def\omitkeyword{omit}%
5400 \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
5401 \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
5402 \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
5403 \iftocfileopened\else
5404 \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc
5405 \global\tocfileopenedtrue
5408 \iflinks
5409 {\atdummies
5410 \edef\temp{%
5411 \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
5412 \temp
5417 % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
5418 % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
5419 % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
5420 % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
5421 % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
5422 % `1', and two named `2'.
5423 \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi
5427 % These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
5428 % fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
5429 % with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
5431 \def\activecatcodes{%
5432 \catcode`\"=\active
5433 \catcode`\$=\active
5434 \catcode`\<=\active
5435 \catcode`\>=\active
5436 \catcode`\\=\active
5437 \catcode`\^=\active
5438 \catcode`\_=\active
5439 \catcode`\|=\active
5440 \catcode`\~=\active
5444 % Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
5445 \def\readtocfile{%
5446 \setupdatafile
5447 \activecatcodes
5448 \input \tocreadfilename
5451 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
5452 \newcount\savepageno
5453 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1
5455 % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
5457 \def\startcontents#1{%
5458 % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
5459 % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
5460 % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
5461 % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se>
5462 \contentsalignmacro
5463 \immediate\closeout\tocfile
5465 % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
5466 % It is abundantly clear what they are.
5467 \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
5469 \savepageno = \pageno
5470 \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
5471 \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
5472 \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
5474 % Roman numerals for page numbers.
5475 \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
5478 % redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on
5479 % \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
5481 \def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc}
5483 % Normal (long) toc.
5485 \def\contents{%
5486 \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
5487 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
5488 \ifeof 1 \else
5489 \readtocfile
5491 \vfill \eject
5492 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
5493 \ifeof 1 \else
5494 \pdfmakeoutlines
5496 \closein 1
5497 \endgroup
5498 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
5499 \global\pageno = \savepageno
5502 % And just the chapters.
5503 \def\summarycontents{%
5504 \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
5506 \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
5507 \let\appentry = \shortchapentry
5508 \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
5509 % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
5510 \secfonts
5511 \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf
5512 \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt
5514 \hyphenpenalty = 10000
5515 \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
5516 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{}
5517 \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry
5518 \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry
5519 \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5520 \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5521 \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5522 \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5523 \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5524 \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5525 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
5526 \ifeof 1 \else
5527 \readtocfile
5529 \closein 1
5530 \vfill \eject
5531 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
5532 \endgroup
5533 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
5534 \global\pageno = \savepageno
5536 \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents
5538 % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
5539 % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
5541 \def\shortchaplabel#1{%
5542 % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
5543 % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
5544 % But use \hss just in case.
5545 % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
5546 % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
5548 % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
5549 % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
5550 % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
5551 % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
5552 % there are before deciding ...
5553 \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}%
5556 % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
5557 % The first argument is the chapter or section name.
5558 % The last argument is the page number.
5559 % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
5561 % Chapters, in the main contents.
5562 \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5564 % Chapters, in the short toc.
5565 % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
5566 \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
5567 \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
5570 % Appendices, in the main contents.
5571 % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
5573 \def\appendixbox#1{%
5574 % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
5575 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}%
5576 \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
5578 \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5580 % Unnumbered chapters.
5581 \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
5582 \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
5584 % Sections.
5585 \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5586 \let\appsecentry=\numsecentry
5587 \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
5589 % Subsections.
5590 \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5591 \let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry
5592 \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
5594 % And subsubsections.
5595 \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5596 \let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry
5597 \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
5599 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
5600 % Same as \defaultparindent.
5601 \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt
5603 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
5604 % page number.
5606 % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
5607 % if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
5608 \def\dochapentry#1#2{%
5609 \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip
5610 \begingroup
5611 \chapentryfonts
5612 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5613 \endgroup
5614 \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip
5617 \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
5618 \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent
5619 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5620 \endgroup}
5622 \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
5623 \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent
5624 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5625 \endgroup}
5627 \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
5628 \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent
5629 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5630 \endgroup}
5632 % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
5633 \let\tocentry = \entry
5635 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
5636 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
5638 \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
5639 \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
5641 \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
5642 \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
5643 \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
5644 \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
5647 \message{environments,}
5648 % @foo ... @end foo.
5650 % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
5652 % Since these characters are used in examples, it should be an even number of
5653 % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
5655 \def\point{$\star$}
5656 \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.15ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
5657 \def\expansion{\leavevmode\raise.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
5658 \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
5659 \def\equiv{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
5661 % The @error{} command.
5662 % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
5664 \newbox\errorbox
5666 {\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
5667 \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
5668 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
5669 \setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf error\kern-1.5pt}
5671 \setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
5672 \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
5673 \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
5674 \vbox{%
5675 \hrule height\dimen2
5676 \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
5677 \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
5678 \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
5679 \hrule height\dimen2}
5680 \hfil}
5682 \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
5684 % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily.
5685 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
5686 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character.
5688 \envdef\tex{%
5689 \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
5690 \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
5691 \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie
5692 \catcode `\%=14
5693 \catcode `\+=\other
5694 \catcode `\"=\other
5695 \catcode `\|=\other
5696 \catcode `\<=\other
5697 \catcode `\>=\other
5698 \escapechar=`\\
5700 \let\b=\ptexb
5701 \let\bullet=\ptexbullet
5702 \let\c=\ptexc
5703 \let\,=\ptexcomma
5704 \let\.=\ptexdot
5705 \let\dots=\ptexdots
5706 \let\equiv=\ptexequiv
5707 \let\!=\ptexexclam
5708 \let\i=\ptexi
5709 \let\indent=\ptexindent
5710 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
5711 \let\{=\ptexlbrace
5712 \let\+=\tabalign
5713 \let\}=\ptexrbrace
5714 \let\/=\ptexslash
5715 \let\*=\ptexstar
5716 \let\t=\ptext
5717 \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing
5719 \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
5720 \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}%
5721 \def\@{@}%
5723 % There is no need to define \Etex.
5725 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
5726 % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
5727 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
5729 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
5730 \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in
5732 % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
5733 % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
5734 % have any width.
5735 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
5737 % This space is always present above and below environments.
5738 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt
5740 % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
5741 % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
5742 % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
5743 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
5745 \def\aboveenvbreak{{%
5746 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
5747 % \sectionheading, q.v.
5748 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
5749 \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
5750 \endgraf
5751 \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
5752 \removelastskip
5753 % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
5754 % or better ...
5755 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi
5756 \vskip\envskipamount
5761 \let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak
5763 % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
5764 % also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
5765 \let\nonarrowing=\relax
5767 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
5768 % environment contents.
5769 \font\circle=lcircle10
5770 \newdimen\circthick
5771 \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
5772 \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
5773 \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle
5775 \def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
5776 \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}}
5777 \def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}}
5778 \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}}
5779 \def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
5780 \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr
5781 \hskip\rskip}}
5782 \def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
5783 \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr
5784 \hskip\rskip}}
5786 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
5788 \envdef\cartouche{%
5789 \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
5790 \startsavinginserts
5791 \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
5792 \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*.
5793 \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
5794 \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
5795 \cartouter=\hsize
5796 \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either
5797 % side, and for 6pt waste from
5798 % each corner char, and rule thickness
5799 \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
5800 % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin.
5801 \let\nonarrowing = t%
5802 \vbox\bgroup
5803 \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
5804 \carttop
5805 \hbox\bgroup
5806 \hskip\lskip
5807 \vrule\kern3pt
5808 \vbox\bgroup
5809 \kern3pt
5810 \hsize=\cartinner
5811 \baselineskip=\normbskip
5812 \lineskip=\normlskip
5813 \parskip=\normpskip
5814 \vskip -\parskip
5815 \comment % For explanation, see the end of \def\group.
5817 \def\Ecartouche{%
5818 \ifhmode\par\fi
5819 \kern3pt
5820 \egroup
5821 \kern3pt\vrule
5822 \hskip\rskip
5823 \egroup
5824 \cartbot
5825 \egroup
5826 \checkinserts
5830 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
5831 % inside a group.
5832 \def\nonfillstart{%
5833 \aboveenvbreak
5834 \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy
5835 \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
5836 \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
5837 \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
5838 \parskip = 0pt
5839 \parindent = 0pt
5840 \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
5841 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
5842 \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
5843 \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing
5844 \else
5845 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
5847 \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
5850 % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
5851 % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
5852 % This affects the following displayed environments:
5853 % @example, @display, @format, @lisp
5855 \def\smallword{small}
5856 \def\nosmallword{nosmall}
5857 \let\SETdispenvsize\relax
5858 \def\setnormaldispenv{%
5859 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
5860 % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank
5861 % line. This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but
5862 % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient
5863 % to change the fonts afterward.
5864 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
5865 \smallexamplefonts \rm
5868 \def\setsmalldispenv{%
5869 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
5870 \else
5871 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
5872 \smallexamplefonts \rm
5876 % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
5877 % Let's do it by one command:
5878 \def\makedispenv #1#2{
5879 \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}
5880 \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}
5881 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
5882 \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
5885 % Define two synonyms:
5886 \def\maketwodispenvs #1#2#3{
5887 \makedispenv{#1}{#3}
5888 \makedispenv{#2}{#3}
5891 % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; @example: same as @lisp.
5893 % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
5894 % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
5896 \maketwodispenvs {lisp}{example}{%
5897 \nonfillstart
5898 \tt\quoteexpand
5899 \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
5900 \gobble % eat return
5902 % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
5904 \makedispenv {display}{%
5905 \nonfillstart
5906 \gobble
5909 % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
5911 \makedispenv{format}{%
5912 \let\nonarrowing = t%
5913 \nonfillstart
5914 \gobble
5917 % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
5918 \envdef\flushleft{%
5919 \let\nonarrowing = t%
5920 \nonfillstart
5921 \gobble
5923 \let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak
5925 % @flushright.
5927 \envdef\flushright{%
5928 \let\nonarrowing = t%
5929 \nonfillstart
5930 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill
5931 \gobble
5933 \let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak
5936 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
5937 % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
5938 % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
5939 % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
5941 \envdef\quotation{%
5942 {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
5943 \parindent=0pt
5945 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
5946 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
5947 \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
5948 \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
5949 \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
5950 \else
5951 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
5953 \parsearg\quotationlabel
5956 % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
5957 % doing normal filling.
5959 \def\Equotation{%
5960 \par
5961 \ifx\quotationauthor\undefined\else
5962 % indent a bit.
5963 \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}%
5965 {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
5968 % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
5969 \def\quotationlabel#1{%
5970 \def\temp{#1}%
5971 \ifx\temp\empty \else
5972 {\bf #1: }%
5977 % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
5978 % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
5979 % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
5980 % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org
5982 % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
5984 % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
5985 % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
5986 % verbatim line.
5987 \def\dospecials{%
5988 \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&%
5989 \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~%
5990 \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"%
5993 % [Knuth] p. 380
5994 \def\uncatcodespecials{%
5995 \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials}
5997 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
5998 % Disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font
5999 \begingroup
6000 \catcode`\`=\active\gdef`{\relax\lq}
6001 \endgroup
6003 % Setup for the @verb command.
6005 % Eight spaces for a tab
6006 \begingroup
6007 \catcode`\^^I=\active
6008 \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }}
6009 \endgroup
6011 \def\setupverb{%
6012 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
6013 \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
6014 \catcode`\`=\active
6015 \tabeightspaces
6016 % Respect line breaks,
6017 % print special symbols as themselves, and
6018 % make each space count
6019 % must do in this order:
6020 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
6023 % Setup for the @verbatim environment
6025 % Real tab expansion
6026 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount
6028 \def\starttabbox{\setbox0=\hbox\bgroup}
6030 % Allow an option to not replace quotes with a regular directed right
6031 % quote/apostrophe (char 0x27), but instead use the undirected quote
6032 % from cmtt (char 0x0d). The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it
6033 % the default, but it works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least
6034 % evince), the lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the
6035 % regular 0x27.
6037 \def\codequoteright{%
6038 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
6039 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
6041 \else \char'15 \fi
6042 \else \char'15 \fi
6045 % and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
6046 % Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
6047 % the code environments to do likewise.
6049 \def\codequoteleft{%
6050 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
6051 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
6053 \else \char'22 \fi
6054 \else \char'22 \fi
6057 \begingroup
6058 \catcode`\^^I=\active
6059 \gdef\tabexpand{%
6060 \catcode`\^^I=\active
6061 \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup
6062 \dimen0=\wd0 % the width so far, or since the previous tab
6063 \divide\dimen0 by\tabw
6064 \multiply\dimen0 by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
6065 \advance\dimen0 by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
6066 \wd0=\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox
6069 \catcode`\'=\active
6070 \gdef\rquoteexpand{\catcode\rquoteChar=\active \def'{\codequoteright}}%
6072 \catcode`\`=\active
6073 \gdef\lquoteexpand{\catcode\lquoteChar=\active \def`{\codequoteleft}}%
6075 \gdef\quoteexpand{\rquoteexpand \lquoteexpand}%
6076 \endgroup
6078 % start the verbatim environment.
6079 \def\setupverbatim{%
6080 \let\nonarrowing = t%
6081 \nonfillstart
6082 % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
6084 \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}%
6085 \catcode`\`=\active
6086 \tabexpand
6087 \quoteexpand
6088 % Respect line breaks,
6089 % print special symbols as themselves, and
6090 % make each space count
6091 % must do in this order:
6092 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
6093 \everypar{\starttabbox}%
6096 % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
6097 % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
6098 % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
6100 % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
6102 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
6103 \begingroup
6104 \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other
6105 \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next]
6106 \endgroup
6108 \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
6111 % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
6112 % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
6114 % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
6116 % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
6117 % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
6118 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
6120 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
6122 \begingroup
6123 \catcode`\ =\active
6124 \obeylines %
6125 % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
6126 % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
6127 % line in the output.
6128 \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}%
6129 % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
6130 % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
6131 \endgroup
6133 \envdef\verbatim{%
6134 \setupverbatim\doverbatim
6136 \let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak
6139 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
6141 \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
6143 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
6145 \makevalueexpandable
6146 \setupverbatim
6147 \input #1
6148 \afterenvbreak
6152 % @copying ... @end copying.
6153 % Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
6155 % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
6156 % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
6157 % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
6158 % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
6159 % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
6160 % possible is very desirable.
6162 \def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
6163 \def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
6165 \def\insertcopying{%
6166 \begingroup
6167 \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
6168 \scanexp\copyingtext
6169 \endgroup
6173 \message{defuns,}
6174 % @defun etc.
6176 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
6177 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
6178 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
6179 \newcount\defunpenalty
6181 % Start the processing of @deffn:
6182 \def\startdefun{%
6183 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
6184 \medbreak
6185 \defunpenalty=10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
6186 % following @def command, see below.
6187 \else
6188 % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
6189 % which is there to keep the function description together with its
6190 % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
6191 % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
6192 % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
6193 % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
6194 % a break between a section heading and a defun.
6196 % As a minor refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
6197 % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
6198 % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
6199 % @def command.
6200 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
6202 % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
6203 % But do insert the glue.
6204 \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
6207 \parindent=0in
6208 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
6209 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
6212 \def\dodefunx#1{%
6213 % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
6214 \checkenv#1%
6216 % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
6217 % It's not a great place, though.
6218 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
6220 % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
6221 \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
6223 \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
6225 % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
6227 \def\printdefunline#1#2{%
6228 \begingroup
6229 % call \deffnheader:
6230 #1#2 \endheader
6231 % common ending:
6232 \interlinepenalty = 10000
6233 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil
6234 \endgraf
6235 \nobreak\vskip -\parskip
6236 \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
6237 % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
6238 % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
6239 \checkparencounts
6240 \endgroup
6243 \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
6245 % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
6246 % the only thing remainnig is to define \deffnheader.
6248 \def\makedefun#1{%
6249 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun
6250 \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
6251 \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}%
6252 \temp
6255 % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader
6257 % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
6258 % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
6260 \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
6261 \envdef#1{%
6262 \startdefun
6263 \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
6265 \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
6266 \def#3%
6269 %%% Untyped functions:
6271 % @deffn category name args
6272 \makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}}
6274 % @deffn category class name args
6275 \makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
6277 % \defopon {category on}class name args
6278 \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
6280 % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
6282 \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
6283 % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
6284 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
6285 \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
6288 %%% Typed functions:
6290 % @deftypefn category type name args
6291 \makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
6293 % @deftypeop category class type name args
6294 \makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
6296 % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
6297 \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
6299 % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
6301 \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
6302 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
6303 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
6306 %%% Typed variables:
6308 % @deftypevr category type var args
6309 \makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
6311 % @deftypecv category class type var args
6312 \makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
6314 % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
6315 \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
6317 % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
6319 \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
6320 \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
6321 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
6324 %%% Untyped variables:
6326 % @defvr category var args
6327 \makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
6329 % @defcv category class var args
6330 \makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
6332 % \defcvof {category of}class var args
6333 \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
6335 %%% Type:
6336 % @deftp category name args
6337 \makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
6338 \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}%
6339 \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
6342 % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
6343 \makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
6344 \makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
6345 \makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
6346 \makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
6347 \makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
6348 \makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
6349 \makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
6350 \makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
6351 \makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
6352 \makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
6353 \makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
6355 % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
6356 % #1 is the category, such as "Function".
6357 % #2 is the return type, if any.
6358 % #3 is the function name.
6360 % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
6362 \def\defname#1#2#3{%
6363 % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
6364 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
6366 % How we'll format the type name. Putting it in brackets helps
6367 % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
6368 % just below it.
6369 \def\temp{#1}%
6370 \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
6372 % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape.
6373 % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
6374 % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
6375 \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip
6376 % The continuations:
6377 \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent
6378 % (plain.tex says that \dimen1 should be used only as global.)
6379 \parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen2
6381 % Put the type name to the right margin.
6382 \noindent
6383 \hbox to 0pt{%
6384 \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize
6385 % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
6386 \kern\leftskip
6387 % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
6390 % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
6391 \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
6392 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
6394 % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
6395 % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
6396 % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
6397 % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
6398 % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
6399 % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
6400 % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
6401 % one has made identifiers using them :).
6402 \df \tt
6403 \def\temp{#2}% return value type
6404 \ifx\temp\empty\else \tclose{\temp} \fi
6405 #3% output function name
6407 {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm
6409 \boldbrax
6410 % arguments will be output next, if any.
6413 % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
6414 % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
6415 % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
6416 % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
6418 \def\defunargs#1{%
6419 % use sl by default (not ttsl),
6420 % tt for the names.
6421 \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0
6423 % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
6424 % want a way to get ttsl. Let's try @var for that.
6425 \let\var=\ttslanted
6427 \sl\hyphenchar\font=45
6430 % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
6432 \def\activeparens{%
6433 \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active
6434 \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active
6435 \catcode`\&=\active
6438 % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
6439 \let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
6441 % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
6442 % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
6443 % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
6445 \activeparens
6446 \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
6447 \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
6448 \global\let& = \&
6450 \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
6451 \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm}
6454 \newcount\parencount
6456 % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
6457 \newif\ifampseen
6458 \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\&#1 }}
6460 \def\parenfont{%
6461 \ifampseen
6462 % At the first level, print parens in roman,
6463 % otherwise use the default font.
6464 \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi
6465 \else
6466 % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
6467 % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
6471 \def\infirstlevel#1{%
6472 \ifampseen
6473 \ifnum\parencount=1
6478 \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
6480 \def\opnr{%
6481 \global\advance\parencount by 1
6482 {\parenfont(}%
6483 \infirstlevel \bfafterword
6485 \def\clnr{%
6486 {\parenfont)}%
6487 \infirstlevel \sl
6488 \global\advance\parencount by -1
6491 \newcount\brackcount
6492 \def\lbrb{%
6493 \global\advance\brackcount by 1
6494 {\bf[}%
6496 \def\rbrb{%
6497 {\bf]}%
6498 \global\advance\brackcount by -1
6501 \def\checkparencounts{%
6502 \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi
6503 \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
6505 % these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually
6506 % has such constructs (when documenting function pointers).
6507 \def\badparencount{%
6508 \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...}%
6509 \global\parencount=0
6511 \def\badbrackcount{%
6512 \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...}%
6513 \global\brackcount=0
6517 \message{macros,}
6518 % @macro.
6520 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
6521 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
6522 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined
6523 \newwrite\macscribble
6524 \def\scantokens#1{%
6525 \toks0={#1}%
6526 \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
6527 \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
6528 \immediate\closeout\macscribble
6529 \input \jobname.tmp
6533 \def\scanmacro#1{%
6534 \begingroup
6535 \newlinechar`\^^M
6536 \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces
6537 % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
6538 % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active
6539 % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had
6540 % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears
6541 % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04
6542 \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@
6543 % ... and \example
6544 \spaceisspace
6546 % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline.
6547 % I've verified that it is necessary both for e-TeX and for ordinary TeX
6548 % --kasal, 29nov03
6549 \scantokens{#1\endinput}%
6550 \endgroup
6553 \def\scanexp#1{%
6554 \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}%
6555 \temp
6558 \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
6559 \newtoks\macname % Macro name
6560 \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
6562 % List of all defined macros in the form
6563 % \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2...
6564 % Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
6565 % if there is a need.
6566 \def\macrolist{}
6568 % Add the macro to \macrolist
6569 \def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
6570 \def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
6571 \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}%
6572 \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
6575 % Utility routines.
6576 % This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
6577 % \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
6578 % (except of course we have to play expansion games).
6580 \def\cslet#1#2{%
6581 \expandafter\let
6582 \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
6583 \csname#2\endcsname
6586 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
6587 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
6588 {\catcode`\@=11
6589 \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }}
6590 \gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@}
6591 \gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @}
6592 \def\unbrace#1{#1}
6593 \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1}
6596 % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
6597 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3%
6598 \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}%
6599 \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}%
6600 \gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}%
6603 % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
6604 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
6605 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \.
6607 % Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate
6608 % them to avoid their expansion. Must do this non-globally, to
6609 % confine the change to the current group.
6611 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
6612 % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
6613 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
6615 \def\scanctxt{%
6616 \catcode`\"=\other
6617 \catcode`\+=\other
6618 \catcode`\<=\other
6619 \catcode`\>=\other
6620 \catcode`\@=\other
6621 \catcode`\^=\other
6622 \catcode`\_=\other
6623 \catcode`\|=\other
6624 \catcode`\~=\other
6625 \ifx\declaredencoding\ascii \else \setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal\other \fi
6628 \def\scanargctxt{%
6629 \scanctxt
6630 \catcode`\\=\other
6631 \catcode`\^^M=\other
6634 \def\macrobodyctxt{%
6635 \scanctxt
6636 \catcode`\{=\other
6637 \catcode`\}=\other
6638 \catcode`\^^M=\other
6639 \usembodybackslash
6642 \def\macroargctxt{%
6643 \scanctxt
6644 \catcode`\\=\other
6647 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
6648 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
6649 % where N is the macro parameter number.
6650 % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
6651 % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
6653 {\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
6654 @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash}
6655 @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname}
6657 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash}
6659 \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
6660 \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
6662 \def\macroxxx#1{%
6663 \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
6664 \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
6665 \paramno=0%
6666 \else
6667 \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;%
6669 \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname
6670 \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}%
6671 \else
6672 \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
6673 \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi
6674 \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
6675 \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1%
6676 \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
6678 \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
6679 \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
6680 \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
6681 \fi}
6683 \parseargdef\unmacro{%
6684 \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname
6685 \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}%
6686 \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0%
6687 % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
6688 \begingroup
6689 \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
6690 \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo
6691 \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
6692 \endgroup
6693 \else
6694 \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}%
6698 % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
6699 % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
6701 \def\unmacrodo#1{%
6702 \ifx #1\relax
6703 % remove this
6704 \else
6705 \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1%
6709 % This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a
6710 % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
6711 % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
6712 \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
6713 \def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
6714 \def\getmacname #1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}}
6715 \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
6717 % Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist
6718 % so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.blah for each blah
6719 % in the params list, to be ##N where N is the position in that list.
6720 % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
6722 % We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions.
6723 % The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something
6724 % unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine
6725 % it to # just before using the token list produced.
6727 % The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before
6728 % the macro is used.
6730 \def\parsemargdef#1;{\paramno=0\def\paramlist{}%
6731 \let\hash\relax\let\xeatspaces\relax\parsemargdefxxx#1,;,}
6732 \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{%
6733 \if#1;\let\next=\relax
6734 \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx
6735 \advance\paramno by 1%
6736 \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
6737 {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
6738 \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}%
6739 \fi\next}
6741 % These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies.
6742 % (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
6744 \long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro%
6745 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
6746 \long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro%
6747 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
6749 % This defines the macro itself. There are six cases: recursive and
6750 % nonrecursive macros of zero, one, and many arguments.
6751 % Much magic with \expandafter here.
6752 % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
6753 % they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group.
6754 \def\defmacro{%
6755 \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
6756 \ifrecursive
6757 \ifcase\paramno
6759 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6760 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
6761 \or % 1
6762 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6763 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6764 \noexpand\braceorline
6765 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
6766 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
6767 \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
6768 \else % many
6769 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6770 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6771 \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
6772 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
6773 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
6774 \expandafter\expandafter
6775 \expandafter\xdef
6776 \expandafter\expandafter
6777 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
6778 \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
6780 \else
6781 \ifcase\paramno
6783 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6784 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
6785 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
6786 \or % 1
6787 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6788 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6789 \noexpand\braceorline
6790 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
6791 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
6792 \egroup
6793 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
6794 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
6795 \else % many
6796 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6797 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6798 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
6799 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
6800 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
6801 \expandafter\expandafter
6802 \expandafter\xdef
6803 \expandafter\expandafter
6804 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
6805 \paramlist{%
6806 \egroup
6807 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
6808 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
6810 \fi}
6812 \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}}
6814 % \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a
6815 % {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole
6816 % line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence
6817 % as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg)
6818 \def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
6819 \def\braceorlinexxx{%
6820 \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else
6821 \expandafter\parsearg
6822 \fi \macnamexxx}
6825 % @alias.
6826 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
6827 % sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
6828 \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
6829 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
6830 \def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{%
6832 \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty
6833 \addtomacrolist{#1}%
6834 \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}%
6836 \next
6840 \message{cross references,}
6842 \newwrite\auxfile
6843 \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
6844 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
6846 % @inforef is relatively simple.
6847 \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**}
6848 \def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
6849 node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
6851 % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
6852 % cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
6853 % might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
6854 % @node foo , bar , ...
6855 % We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
6857 \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse}
6859 % also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
6860 % @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
6861 \def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse}
6862 \def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
6864 \let\nwnode=\node
6865 \let\lastnode=\empty
6867 % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
6868 % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
6870 \def\donoderef#1{%
6871 \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
6872 \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
6873 \global\let\lastnode=\empty
6877 % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
6879 \newcount\savesfregister
6881 \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
6882 \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
6883 \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
6885 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
6886 % anchor), which consists of three parts:
6887 % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \lastsection,
6888 % or the anchor name.
6889 % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
6890 % empty for anchors.
6891 % 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
6893 % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
6894 % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
6895 % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
6897 \def\setref#1#2{%
6898 \pdfmkdest{#1}%
6899 \iflinks
6901 \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
6902 \edef\writexrdef##1##2{%
6903 \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
6904 ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
6906 \toks0 = \expandafter{\lastsection}%
6907 \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }%
6908 \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
6909 \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg}{\folio}}% will be written later, during \shipout
6914 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
6915 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
6916 % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
6917 % manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
6919 \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
6920 \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
6921 \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
6922 \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
6923 \unsepspaces
6924 \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
6925 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
6926 \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
6927 \setbox0=\hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
6928 \ifdim \wd0 = 0pt
6929 % No printed node name was explicitly given.
6930 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname\relax
6931 % Use the node name inside the square brackets.
6932 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
6933 \else
6934 % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside
6935 % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it.
6936 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
6937 % It is in another manual, so we don't have it.
6938 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
6939 \else
6940 \ifhavexrefs
6941 % We know the real title if we have the xref values.
6942 \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
6943 \else
6944 % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
6945 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
6946 \fi%
6951 % Make link in pdf output.
6952 \ifpdf
6953 \leavevmode
6954 \getfilename{#4}%
6955 {\indexnofonts
6956 \turnoffactive
6957 % See comments at \activebackslashdouble.
6958 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfxrefdest{#1}%
6959 \backslashparens\pdfxrefdest}%
6961 \ifnum\filenamelength>0
6962 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
6963 goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfxrefdest}%
6964 \else
6965 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
6966 goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}%
6969 \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
6972 % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
6973 % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the
6974 % LABEL-title being set to a magic string.
6976 % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
6977 % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
6978 \indexnofonts
6979 \turnoffactive
6980 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
6981 \csname XR#1-title\endcsname
6983 \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
6984 % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
6985 % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
6986 \ifdim\wd0 = 0pt
6987 \refx{#1-snt}{}%
6988 \else
6989 \printedrefname
6992 % if the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
6993 % "in MANUALNAME".
6994 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
6995 \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
6997 \else
6998 % node/anchor (non-float) references.
7000 % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not
7001 % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will
7002 % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
7003 % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this
7004 % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it
7005 % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
7006 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
7007 \putwordSection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
7008 \else
7009 % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
7010 % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
7011 % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
7012 % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
7013 % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
7014 {\turnoffactive
7015 % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
7016 % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
7017 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
7018 \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
7020 % output the `[mynode]' via a macro so it can be overridden.
7021 \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
7023 % But we always want a comma and a space:
7024 ,\space
7026 % output the `page 3'.
7027 \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
7030 \endlink
7031 \endgroup}
7033 % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
7034 % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
7035 % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
7036 % one that Bob is working on :).
7038 \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
7040 % Things referred to by \setref.
7042 \def\Ynothing{}
7043 \def\Yomitfromtoc{}
7044 \def\Ynumbered{%
7045 \ifnum\secno=0
7046 \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno
7047 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
7048 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno
7049 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
7050 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
7051 \else
7052 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
7053 \fi\fi\fi
7055 \def\Yappendix{%
7056 \ifnum\secno=0
7057 \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}%
7058 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
7059 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno
7060 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
7061 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
7062 \else
7063 \putwordSection@tie
7064 @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
7065 \fi\fi\fi
7068 % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME.
7069 % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward.
7071 \def\refx#1#2{%
7073 \indexnofonts
7074 \otherbackslash
7075 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
7076 \csname XR#1\endcsname
7078 \ifx\thisrefX\relax
7079 % If not defined, say something at least.
7080 \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright
7081 \iflinks
7082 \ifhavexrefs
7083 \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}%
7084 \else
7085 \ifwarnedxrefs\else
7086 \global\warnedxrefstrue
7087 \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}%
7091 \else
7092 % It's defined, so just use it.
7093 \thisrefX
7095 #2% Output the suffix in any case.
7098 % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's
7099 % just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid
7100 % collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do.
7102 \def\xrdef#1#2{%
7103 {% The node name might contain 8-bit characters, which in our current
7104 % implementation are changed to commands like @'e. Don't let these
7105 % mess up the control sequence name.
7106 \indexnofonts
7107 \turnoffactive
7108 \xdef\safexrefname{#1}%
7111 \expandafter\gdef\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref
7113 % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
7114 \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname
7115 % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
7116 \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
7117 \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname
7119 % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
7120 \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
7121 \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do
7122 \else
7123 % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
7124 \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
7127 % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
7128 % for later use in \listoffloats.
7129 \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0
7130 {\safexrefname}}%
7134 % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
7136 \def\tryauxfile{%
7137 \openin 1 \jobname.aux
7138 \ifeof 1 \else
7139 \readdatafile{aux}%
7140 \global\havexrefstrue
7142 \closein 1
7145 \def\setupdatafile{%
7146 \catcode`\^^@=\other
7147 \catcode`\^^A=\other
7148 \catcode`\^^B=\other
7149 \catcode`\^^C=\other
7150 \catcode`\^^D=\other
7151 \catcode`\^^E=\other
7152 \catcode`\^^F=\other
7153 \catcode`\^^G=\other
7154 \catcode`\^^H=\other
7155 \catcode`\^^K=\other
7156 \catcode`\^^L=\other
7157 \catcode`\^^N=\other
7158 \catcode`\^^P=\other
7159 \catcode`\^^Q=\other
7160 \catcode`\^^R=\other
7161 \catcode`\^^S=\other
7162 \catcode`\^^T=\other
7163 \catcode`\^^U=\other
7164 \catcode`\^^V=\other
7165 \catcode`\^^W=\other
7166 \catcode`\^^X=\other
7167 \catcode`\^^Z=\other
7168 \catcode`\^^[=\other
7169 \catcode`\^^\=\other
7170 \catcode`\^^]=\other
7171 \catcode`\^^^=\other
7172 \catcode`\^^_=\other
7173 % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
7174 % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't
7175 % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore,
7176 % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^
7177 % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat
7178 % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first
7179 % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could
7180 % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't.
7182 % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat:
7183 % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter
7184 % and then to call \auxhat in \setq.
7186 \catcode`\^=\other
7188 % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
7189 \catcode`\~=\other
7190 \catcode`\[=\other
7191 \catcode`\]=\other
7192 \catcode`\"=\other
7193 \catcode`\_=\other
7194 \catcode`\|=\other
7195 \catcode`\<=\other
7196 \catcode`\>=\other
7197 \catcode`\$=\other
7198 \catcode`\#=\other
7199 \catcode`\&=\other
7200 \catcode`\%=\other
7201 \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
7203 % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
7204 % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than
7205 % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
7206 % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
7207 % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
7208 % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for
7209 % now. --karl, 15jan04.
7210 \catcode`\\=\other
7212 % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters.
7214 \count1=128
7215 \def\loop{%
7216 \catcode\count1=\other
7217 \advance\count1 by 1
7218 \ifnum \count1<256 \loop \fi
7222 % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
7223 \catcode`\{=1
7224 \catcode`\}=2
7225 \catcode`\@=0
7228 \def\readdatafile#1{%
7229 \begingroup
7230 \setupdatafile
7231 \input\jobname.#1
7232 \endgroup}
7235 \message{insertions,}
7236 % including footnotes.
7238 \newcount \footnoteno
7240 % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
7241 % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
7242 % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
7243 % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
7244 % space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
7245 \def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 }
7247 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only.
7248 \let\footnotestyle=\comment
7250 {\catcode `\@=11
7252 % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
7253 \gdef\footnote{%
7254 \let\indent=\ptexindent
7255 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
7256 \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
7257 \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}%
7259 % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
7260 % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
7261 \let\@sf\empty
7262 \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
7264 % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
7265 \unskip
7266 \thisfootno\@sf
7267 \dofootnote
7270 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
7271 % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
7273 % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
7274 % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
7275 % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
7277 \gdef\dofootnote{%
7278 \insert\footins\bgroup
7279 % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
7280 % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
7281 % So reset some parameters.
7282 \hsize=\pagewidth
7283 \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
7284 \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
7285 \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
7286 \floatingpenalty\@MM
7287 \leftskip\z@skip
7288 \rightskip\z@skip
7289 \spaceskip\z@skip
7290 \xspaceskip\z@skip
7291 \parindent\defaultparindent
7293 \smallfonts \rm
7295 % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
7296 % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
7297 % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
7298 % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
7299 \let\noindent = \relax
7301 % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
7302 % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
7303 \everypar = {\hang}%
7304 \textindent{\thisfootno}%
7306 % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
7307 % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
7308 % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
7309 \footstrut
7310 \futurelet\next\fo@t
7312 }%end \catcode `\@=11
7314 % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
7315 % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
7316 % would be lost.
7317 % Similarily, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
7318 % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
7319 % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
7321 % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
7322 % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
7323 % out prematurely.
7325 \def\startsavinginserts{%
7326 \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
7327 \let\insert\saveinsert
7328 \else
7329 \let\checkinserts\relax
7333 % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
7334 % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
7336 \def\saveinsert#1{%
7337 \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
7338 \afterassignment\next
7339 % swallow the left brace
7340 \let\temp =
7342 \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
7343 \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
7345 \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
7347 \def\placesaveins#1{%
7348 \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
7349 {\box#1}%
7352 % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
7354 \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
7355 \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{}
7358 % initialization:
7359 \def\newsaveins #1{%
7360 \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
7361 \next
7363 \def\newsaveinsX #1{%
7364 \csname newbox\endcsname #1%
7365 \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
7366 \checksaveins #1}%
7369 % initialize:
7370 \let\checkinserts\empty
7371 \newsaveins\footins
7372 \newsaveins\margin
7375 % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
7376 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
7378 % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image
7379 % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
7380 % undone and the next image would fail.
7381 \openin 1 = epsf.tex
7382 \ifeof 1 \else
7383 % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
7384 % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
7385 \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }%
7386 \input epsf.tex
7388 \closein 1
7390 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
7391 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf
7392 \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
7393 work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
7394 it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.}
7396 \def\image#1{%
7397 \ifx\epsfbox\undefined
7398 \ifwarnednoepsf \else
7399 \errhelp = \noepsfhelp
7400 \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}%
7401 \global\warnednoepsftrue
7403 \else
7404 \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish
7408 % Arguments to @image:
7409 % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
7410 % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
7411 % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
7412 % #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
7413 % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff.
7414 \newif\ifimagevmode
7415 \def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup
7416 \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example
7417 \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
7418 % If the image is by itself, center it.
7419 \ifvmode
7420 \imagevmodetrue
7421 \nobreak\bigskip
7422 % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
7423 % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
7424 % above and below.
7425 \nobreak\vskip\parskip
7426 \nobreak
7427 \line\bgroup
7430 % Output the image.
7431 \ifpdf
7432 \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
7433 \else
7434 % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
7435 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi
7436 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi
7437 \epsfbox{#1.eps}%
7440 \ifimagevmode \egroup \bigbreak \fi % space after the image
7441 \endgroup}
7444 % @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
7445 % etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
7446 % float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
7448 \envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish}
7450 % There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
7451 \def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,}
7453 % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
7454 % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted,
7455 % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
7457 % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
7458 % be referable.
7460 % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
7461 % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
7463 % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
7464 % chapter-level command.
7465 \let\resetallfloatnos=\empty
7467 \def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{%
7468 \let\thiscaption=\empty
7469 \let\thisshortcaption=\empty
7471 % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
7473 % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
7474 % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
7476 \startsavinginserts
7478 % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
7479 \par
7481 \vtop\bgroup
7482 \def\floattype{#1}%
7483 \def\floatlabel{#2}%
7484 \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
7486 \ifx\floattype\empty
7487 \let\safefloattype=\empty
7488 \else
7490 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
7491 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
7492 \indexnofonts
7493 \turnoffactive
7494 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
7498 % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
7499 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
7500 % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
7501 % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
7503 \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname
7504 \global\advance\floatno by 1
7507 % This magic value for \lastsection is output by \setref as the
7508 % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
7509 % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
7510 % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
7511 % lists of floats.
7513 \edef\lastsection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
7514 \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}%
7518 % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
7519 \vskip\parskip
7521 % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
7522 \restorefirstparagraphindent
7525 % we have these possibilities:
7526 % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
7527 % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
7528 % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
7529 % @float Foo & no caption: Foo
7530 % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
7531 % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
7532 % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
7533 % @float & no caption:
7535 \def\Efloat{%
7536 \let\floatident = \empty
7538 % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
7539 \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
7541 % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
7542 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
7543 \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
7544 \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
7546 % the number.
7547 \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
7550 % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
7551 % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
7552 \let\captionline = \floatident
7554 \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
7555 \ifx\floatident\empty \else
7556 \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between
7559 % caption text.
7560 \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
7563 % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
7564 % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
7565 \ifx\captionline\empty \else
7566 \vskip.5\parskip
7567 \captionline
7569 % Space below caption.
7570 \vskip\parskip
7573 % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
7574 % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
7575 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
7576 % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
7577 % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
7578 % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
7580 \atdummies
7582 % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M
7583 % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so
7584 % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file.
7585 \scanexp{%
7586 \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{%
7587 \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
7588 \thiscaption
7589 \else
7590 \thisshortcaption
7594 \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident
7595 \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}%
7598 \egroup % end of \vtop
7600 % place the captured inserts
7602 % BEWARE: when the floats start floating, we have to issue warning
7603 % whenever an insert appears inside a float which could possibly
7604 % float. --kasal, 26may04
7606 \checkinserts
7609 % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
7611 \def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
7612 \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
7615 % @caption, @shortcaption
7617 \def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
7618 \def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
7619 \def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
7620 \def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
7622 % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
7623 % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
7624 \def\getfloatno#1{%
7625 \ifx#1\relax
7626 % Haven't seen this figure type before.
7627 \csname newcount\endcsname #1%
7629 % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
7630 \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
7631 \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }%
7633 \let\floatno#1%
7636 % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
7637 % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
7638 % first read the @float command.
7640 \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
7642 % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
7643 % distinguish floats from other xref types.
7644 \def\floatmagic{!!float!!}
7646 % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
7647 % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
7648 % \lastsection value which we \setref above.
7650 \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish}
7652 % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
7653 % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
7655 \def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{%
7656 \def\temp{#1}%
7657 \def\iffloattype{#2}%
7658 \ifx\temp\floatmagic
7661 % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
7663 \parseargdef\listoffloats{%
7664 \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
7666 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
7667 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
7668 \indexnofonts
7669 \turnoffactive
7670 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
7673 % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
7674 \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
7675 \ifhavexrefs
7676 % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
7677 \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}%
7679 \else
7680 \begingroup
7681 \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
7682 \let\do=\listoffloatsdo
7683 \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname
7684 \endgroup
7688 % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
7689 % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
7690 % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
7691 % has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
7693 % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
7694 % they won't appear in the aux file).
7696 \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
7697 \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{%
7698 % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
7699 % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
7700 % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
7701 % in pdf output.
7702 \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}%
7704 % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
7705 \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}%
7706 \writeentry
7710 \message{localization,}
7712 % @documentlanguage is usually given very early, just after
7713 % @setfilename. If done too late, it may not override everything
7714 % properly. Single argument is the language (de) or locale (de_DE)
7715 % abbreviation. It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file.
7718 \catcode`\_ = \active
7719 \globaldefs=1
7720 \parseargdef\documentlanguage{\begingroup
7721 \let_=\normalunderscore % normal _ character for filenames
7722 \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
7723 % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
7724 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
7725 \ifeof 1
7726 \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore{#1_\finish}%
7727 \else
7728 \input txi-#1.tex
7730 \closein 1
7731 \endgroup
7732 \endgroup}
7735 % If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
7736 % try txi-de.tex.
7738 \def\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_#2\finish{%
7739 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
7740 \ifeof 1
7741 \errhelp = \nolanghelp
7742 \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
7743 \else
7744 \input txi-#1.tex
7746 \closein 1
7749 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
7750 is empty. Maybe you need to install it? In the current directory
7751 should work if nowhere else does.}
7753 % Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
7755 \def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
7756 \count255=128
7757 \loop\ifnum\count255<256
7758 \global\catcode\count255=#1\relax
7759 \advance\count255 by 1
7760 \repeat
7763 \def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{%
7764 \count255=128
7765 \loop\ifnum\count255<256
7766 \catcode\count255=#1\relax
7767 \advance\count255 by 1
7768 \repeat
7771 % @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
7772 % according to the specified encoding.
7774 \parseargdef\documentencoding{%
7775 % Encoding being declared for the document.
7776 \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc\endcsname}%
7778 % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able
7779 % to compare them with \ifx.
7780 \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc\endcsname}%
7781 \def\latnine{\csname ISO-8859-15.enc\endcsname}%
7782 \def\latone{\csname ISO-8859-1.enc\endcsname}%
7783 \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-8859-2.enc\endcsname}%
7784 \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-8.enc\endcsname}%
7786 \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
7787 \asciichardefs
7789 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo
7790 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7791 \lattwochardefs
7793 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
7794 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7795 \latonechardefs
7797 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine
7798 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7799 \latninechardefs
7801 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
7802 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7803 \utfeightchardefs
7805 \else
7806 \message{Unknown document encoding #1, ignoring.}%
7808 \fi % utfeight
7809 \fi % latnine
7810 \fi % latone
7811 \fi % lattwo
7812 \fi % ascii
7815 % A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
7816 % the default font encoding (OT1).
7818 \def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing in OT1 encoding: #1.}}
7820 % Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
7821 \def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,{#1}\fi}
7823 % First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be
7824 % correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of
7825 % macros containing the character definitions.
7826 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7828 % Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
7829 \def\latonechardefs{%
7830 \gdef^^a0{~}
7831 \gdef^^a1{\exclamdown}
7832 \gdef^^a2{\missingcharmsg{CENT SIGN}}
7833 \gdef^^a3{{\pounds}}
7834 \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
7835 \gdef^^a5{\missingcharmsg{YEN SIGN}}
7836 \gdef^^a6{\missingcharmsg{BROKEN BAR}}
7837 \gdef^^a7{\S}
7838 \gdef^^a8{\"{}}
7839 \gdef^^a9{\copyright}
7840 \gdef^^aa{\ordf}
7841 \gdef^^ab{\missingcharmsg{LEFT-POINTING DOUBLE ANGLE QUOTATION MARK}}
7842 \gdef^^ac{$\lnot$}
7843 \gdef^^ad{\-}
7844 \gdef^^ae{\registeredsymbol}
7845 \gdef^^af{\={}}
7847 \gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
7848 \gdef^^b1{$\pm$}
7849 \gdef^^b2{$^2$}
7850 \gdef^^b3{$^3$}
7851 \gdef^^b4{\'{}}
7852 \gdef^^b5{$\mu$}
7853 \gdef^^b6{\P}
7855 \gdef^^b7{$^.$}
7856 \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ }
7857 \gdef^^b9{$^1$}
7858 \gdef^^ba{\ordm}
7860 \gdef^^bb{\missingcharmsg{RIGHT-POINTING DOUBLE ANGLE QUOTATION MARK}}
7861 \gdef^^bc{$1\over4$}
7862 \gdef^^bd{$1\over2$}
7863 \gdef^^be{$3\over4$}
7864 \gdef^^bf{\questiondown}
7866 \gdef^^c0{\`A}
7867 \gdef^^c1{\'A}
7868 \gdef^^c2{\^A}
7869 \gdef^^c3{\~A}
7870 \gdef^^c4{\"A}
7871 \gdef^^c5{\ringaccent A}
7872 \gdef^^c6{\AE}
7873 \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
7874 \gdef^^c8{\`E}
7875 \gdef^^c9{\'E}
7876 \gdef^^ca{\^E}
7877 \gdef^^cb{\"E}
7878 \gdef^^cc{\`I}
7879 \gdef^^cd{\'I}
7880 \gdef^^ce{\^I}
7881 \gdef^^cf{\"I}
7883 \gdef^^d0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER ETH}}
7884 \gdef^^d1{\~N}
7885 \gdef^^d2{\`O}
7886 \gdef^^d3{\'O}
7887 \gdef^^d4{\^O}
7888 \gdef^^d5{\~O}
7889 \gdef^^d6{\"O}
7890 \gdef^^d7{$\times$}
7891 \gdef^^d8{\O}
7892 \gdef^^d9{\`U}
7893 \gdef^^da{\'U}
7894 \gdef^^db{\^U}
7895 \gdef^^dc{\"U}
7896 \gdef^^dd{\'Y}
7897 \gdef^^de{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER THORN}}
7898 \gdef^^df{\ss}
7900 \gdef^^e0{\`a}
7901 \gdef^^e1{\'a}
7902 \gdef^^e2{\^a}
7903 \gdef^^e3{\~a}
7904 \gdef^^e4{\"a}
7905 \gdef^^e5{\ringaccent a}
7906 \gdef^^e6{\ae}
7907 \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c}
7908 \gdef^^e8{\`e}
7909 \gdef^^e9{\'e}
7910 \gdef^^ea{\^e}
7911 \gdef^^eb{\"e}
7912 \gdef^^ec{\`{\dotless i}}
7913 \gdef^^ed{\'{\dotless i}}
7914 \gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless i}}
7915 \gdef^^ef{\"{\dotless i}}
7917 \gdef^^f0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER ETH}}
7918 \gdef^^f1{\~n}
7919 \gdef^^f2{\`o}
7920 \gdef^^f3{\'o}
7921 \gdef^^f4{\^o}
7922 \gdef^^f5{\~o}
7923 \gdef^^f6{\"o}
7924 \gdef^^f7{$\div$}
7925 \gdef^^f8{\o}
7926 \gdef^^f9{\`u}
7927 \gdef^^fa{\'u}
7928 \gdef^^fb{\^u}
7929 \gdef^^fc{\"u}
7930 \gdef^^fd{\'y}
7931 \gdef^^fe{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER THORN}}
7932 \gdef^^ff{\"y}
7935 % Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions.
7936 \def\latninechardefs{%
7937 % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1.
7938 \latonechardefs
7940 \gdef^^a4{\euro}
7941 \gdef^^a6{\v S}
7942 \gdef^^a8{\v s}
7943 \gdef^^b4{\v Z}
7944 \gdef^^b8{\v z}
7945 \gdef^^bc{\OE}
7946 \gdef^^bd{\oe}
7947 \gdef^^be{\"Y}
7950 % Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
7951 \def\lattwochardefs{%
7952 \gdef^^a0{~}
7953 \gdef^^a1{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A WITH OGONEK}}
7954 \gdef^^a2{\u{}}
7955 \gdef^^a3{\L}
7956 \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
7957 \gdef^^a5{\v L}
7958 \gdef^^a6{\'S}
7959 \gdef^^a7{\S}
7960 \gdef^^a8{\"{}}
7961 \gdef^^a9{\v S}
7962 \gdef^^aa{\cedilla S}
7963 \gdef^^ab{\v T}
7964 \gdef^^ac{\'Z}
7965 \gdef^^ad{\-}
7966 \gdef^^ae{\v Z}
7967 \gdef^^af{\dotaccent Z}
7969 \gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
7970 \gdef^^b1{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER A WITH OGONEK}}
7971 \gdef^^b2{\missingcharmsg{OGONEK}}
7972 \gdef^^b3{\l}
7973 \gdef^^b4{\'{}}
7974 \gdef^^b5{\v l}
7975 \gdef^^b6{\'s}
7976 \gdef^^b7{\v{}}
7977 \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ }
7978 \gdef^^b9{\v s}
7979 \gdef^^ba{\cedilla s}
7980 \gdef^^bb{\v t}
7981 \gdef^^bc{\'z}
7982 \gdef^^bd{\H{}}
7983 \gdef^^be{\v z}
7984 \gdef^^bf{\dotaccent z}
7986 \gdef^^c0{\'R}
7987 \gdef^^c1{\'A}
7988 \gdef^^c2{\^A}
7989 \gdef^^c3{\u A}
7990 \gdef^^c4{\"A}
7991 \gdef^^c5{\'L}
7992 \gdef^^c6{\'C}
7993 \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
7994 \gdef^^c8{\v C}
7995 \gdef^^c9{\'E}
7996 \gdef^^ca{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER E WITH OGONEK}}
7997 \gdef^^cb{\"E}
7998 \gdef^^cc{\v E}
7999 \gdef^^cd{\'I}
8000 \gdef^^ce{\^I}
8001 \gdef^^cf{\v D}
8003 \gdef^^d0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER D WITH STROKE}}
8004 \gdef^^d1{\'N}
8005 \gdef^^d2{\v N}
8006 \gdef^^d3{\'O}
8007 \gdef^^d4{\^O}
8008 \gdef^^d5{\H O}
8009 \gdef^^d6{\"O}
8010 \gdef^^d7{$\times$}
8011 \gdef^^d8{\v R}
8012 \gdef^^d9{\ringaccent U}
8013 \gdef^^da{\'U}
8014 \gdef^^db{\H U}
8015 \gdef^^dc{\"U}
8016 \gdef^^dd{\'Y}
8017 \gdef^^de{\cedilla T}
8018 \gdef^^df{\ss}
8020 \gdef^^e0{\'r}
8021 \gdef^^e1{\'a}
8022 \gdef^^e2{\^a}
8023 \gdef^^e3{\u a}
8024 \gdef^^e4{\"a}
8025 \gdef^^e5{\'l}
8026 \gdef^^e6{\'c}
8027 \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c}
8028 \gdef^^e8{\v c}
8029 \gdef^^e9{\'e}
8030 \gdef^^ea{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER E WITH OGONEK}}
8031 \gdef^^eb{\"e}
8032 \gdef^^ec{\v e}
8033 \gdef^^ed{\'\i}
8034 \gdef^^ee{\^\i}
8035 \gdef^^ef{\v d}
8037 \gdef^^f0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER D WITH STROKE}}
8038 \gdef^^f1{\'n}
8039 \gdef^^f2{\v n}
8040 \gdef^^f3{\'o}
8041 \gdef^^f4{\^o}
8042 \gdef^^f5{\H o}
8043 \gdef^^f6{\"o}
8044 \gdef^^f7{$\div$}
8045 \gdef^^f8{\v r}
8046 \gdef^^f9{\ringaccent u}
8047 \gdef^^fa{\'u}
8048 \gdef^^fb{\H u}
8049 \gdef^^fc{\"u}
8050 \gdef^^fd{\'y}
8051 \gdef^^fe{\cedilla t}
8052 \gdef^^ff{\dotaccent{}}
8055 % UTF-8 character definitions.
8057 % This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
8058 % changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by
8059 % permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
8061 \newcount\countUTFx
8062 \newcount\countUTFy
8063 \newcount\countUTFz
8065 \gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter
8066 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}
8068 \gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter
8069 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}
8071 \gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter
8072 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}
8074 \gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{%
8075 \ifx #1\relax
8076 \message{\linenumber Unicode char \string #1 not defined for Texinfo}%
8077 \else
8078 \expandafter #1%
8082 \begingroup
8083 \catcode`\~13
8084 \catcode`\"12
8086 \def\UTFviiiLoop{%
8087 \global\catcode\countUTFx\active
8088 \uccode`\~\countUTFx
8089 \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}%
8090 \advance\countUTFx by 1
8091 \ifnum\countUTFx < \countUTFy
8092 \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop
8093 \fi}
8095 \countUTFx = "C2
8096 \countUTFy = "E0
8097 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
8098 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiTwoOctets\string~}}
8099 \UTFviiiLoop
8101 \countUTFx = "E0
8102 \countUTFy = "F0
8103 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
8104 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiThreeOctets\string~}}
8105 \UTFviiiLoop
8107 \countUTFx = "F0
8108 \countUTFy = "F4
8109 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
8110 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiFourOctets\string~}}
8111 \UTFviiiLoop
8112 \endgroup
8114 \begingroup
8115 \catcode`\"=12
8116 \catcode`\<=12
8117 \catcode`\.=12
8118 \catcode`\,=12
8119 \catcode`\;=12
8120 \catcode`\!=12
8121 \catcode`\~=13
8123 \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacter#1#2{%
8124 \countUTFz = "#1\relax
8125 \wlog{\space\space defining Unicode char U+#1 (decimal \the\countUTFz)}%
8126 \begingroup
8127 \parseXMLCharref
8128 \def\UTFviiiTwoOctets##1##2{%
8129 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\endcsname}%
8130 \def\UTFviiiThreeOctets##1##2##3{%
8131 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\endcsname}%
8132 \def\UTFviiiFourOctets##1##2##3##4{%
8133 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\string ##4\endcsname}%
8134 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
8135 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
8136 \gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
8137 \endgroup}
8139 \gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
8140 \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0\relax
8141 \errhelp = \EMsimple
8142 \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value < 00A0}%
8143 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "800\relax
8144 \parseUTFviiiA,%
8145 \parseUTFviiiB C\UTFviiiTwoOctets.,%
8146 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "10000\relax
8147 \parseUTFviiiA;%
8148 \parseUTFviiiA,%
8149 \parseUTFviiiB E\UTFviiiThreeOctets.{,;}%
8150 \else
8151 \parseUTFviiiA;%
8152 \parseUTFviiiA,%
8153 \parseUTFviiiA!%
8154 \parseUTFviiiB F\UTFviiiFourOctets.{!,;}%
8155 \fi\fi\fi
8158 \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{%
8159 \countUTFx = \countUTFz
8160 \divide\countUTFz by 64
8161 \countUTFy = \countUTFz
8162 \multiply\countUTFz by 64
8163 \advance\countUTFx by -\countUTFz
8164 \advance\countUTFx by 128
8165 \uccode `#1\countUTFx
8166 \countUTFz = \countUTFy}
8168 \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{%
8169 \advance\countUTFz by "#10\relax
8170 \uccode `#3\countUTFz
8171 \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
8172 \endgroup
8174 \def\utfeightchardefs{%
8175 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0}{\tie}
8176 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1}{\exclamdown}
8177 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3}{\pounds}
8178 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8}{\"{ }}
8179 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9}{\copyright}
8180 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA}{\ordf}
8181 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB}{\guillemetleft}
8182 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD}{\-}
8183 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE}{\registeredsymbol}
8184 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF}{\={ }}
8186 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0}{\ringaccent{ }}
8187 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4}{\'{ }}
8188 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8}{\cedilla{ }}
8189 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA}{\ordm}
8190 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB}{\guillemetright}
8191 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF}{\questiondown}
8193 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0}{\`A}
8194 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1}{\'A}
8195 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2}{\^A}
8196 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3}{\~A}
8197 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4}{\"A}
8198 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5}{\AA}
8199 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6}{\AE}
8200 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7}{\cedilla{C}}
8201 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8}{\`E}
8202 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9}{\'E}
8203 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA}{\^E}
8204 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB}{\"E}
8205 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC}{\`I}
8206 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD}{\'I}
8207 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE}{\^I}
8208 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF}{\"I}
8210 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1}{\~N}
8211 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2}{\`O}
8212 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3}{\'O}
8213 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4}{\^O}
8214 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5}{\~O}
8215 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6}{\"O}
8216 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8}{\O}
8217 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9}{\`U}
8218 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA}{\'U}
8219 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB}{\^U}
8220 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC}{\"U}
8221 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD}{\'Y}
8222 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF}{\ss}
8224 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0}{\`a}
8225 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1}{\'a}
8226 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2}{\^a}
8227 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3}{\~a}
8228 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4}{\"a}
8229 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5}{\aa}
8230 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6}{\ae}
8231 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7}{\cedilla{c}}
8232 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8}{\`e}
8233 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9}{\'e}
8234 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA}{\^e}
8235 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB}{\"e}
8236 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC}{\`{\dotless{i}}}
8237 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED}{\'{\dotless{i}}}
8238 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE}{\^{\dotless{i}}}
8239 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF}{\"{\dotless{i}}}
8241 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1}{\~n}
8242 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2}{\`o}
8243 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3}{\'o}
8244 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4}{\^o}
8245 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5}{\~o}
8246 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6}{\"o}
8247 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8}{\o}
8248 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9}{\`u}
8249 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA}{\'u}
8250 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB}{\^u}
8251 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC}{\"u}
8252 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD}{\'y}
8253 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF}{\"y}
8255 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A}
8256 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a}
8257 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A}}
8258 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a}}
8259 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C}
8260 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c}
8261 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C}
8262 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c}
8263 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A}{\dotaccent{C}}
8264 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B}{\dotaccent{c}}
8265 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C}{\v{C}}
8266 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D}{\v{c}}
8267 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E}{\v{D}}
8269 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E}
8270 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e}
8271 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E}}
8272 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e}}
8273 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E}}
8274 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e}}
8275 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A}{\v{E}}
8276 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B}{\v{e}}
8277 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C}{\^G}
8278 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D}{\^g}
8279 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E}{\u{G}}
8280 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F}{\u{g}}
8282 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G}}
8283 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g}}
8284 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H}
8285 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h}
8286 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I}
8287 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~{\dotless{i}}}
8288 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A}{\=I}
8289 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B}{\={\dotless{i}}}
8290 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C}{\u{I}}
8291 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D}{\u{\dotless{i}}}
8293 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I}}
8294 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i}}
8295 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ}
8296 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij}
8297 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J}
8298 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^{\dotless{j}}}
8299 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L}
8300 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A}{\'l}
8302 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}
8303 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}
8304 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N}
8305 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n}
8306 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N}}
8307 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n}}
8308 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C}{\=O}
8309 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D}{\=o}
8310 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E}{\u{O}}
8311 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F}{\u{o}}
8313 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O}}
8314 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o}}
8315 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE}
8316 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}
8317 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R}
8318 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r}
8319 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R}}
8320 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r}}
8321 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A}{\'S}
8322 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B}{\'s}
8323 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C}{\^S}
8324 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D}{\^s}
8325 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E}{\cedilla{S}}
8326 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F}{\cedilla{s}}
8328 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S}}
8329 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s}}
8330 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{t}}
8331 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{T}}
8332 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T}}
8334 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U}
8335 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u}
8336 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A}{\=U}
8337 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B}{\=u}
8338 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C}{\u{U}}
8339 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D}{\u{u}}
8340 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E}{\ringaccent{U}}
8341 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F}{\ringaccent{u}}
8343 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U}}
8344 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u}}
8345 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W}
8346 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w}
8347 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y}
8348 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y}
8349 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y}
8350 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z}
8351 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A}{\'z}
8352 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B}{\dotaccent{Z}}
8353 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C}{\dotaccent{z}}
8354 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D}{\v{Z}}
8355 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E}{\v{z}}
8357 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4}{D\v{Z}}
8358 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5}{D\v{z}}
8359 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6}{d\v{z}}
8360 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7}{LJ}
8361 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8}{Lj}
8362 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9}{lj}
8363 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA}{NJ}
8364 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB}{Nj}
8365 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC}{nj}
8366 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD}{\v{A}}
8367 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE}{\v{a}}
8368 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF}{\v{I}}
8370 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0}{\v{\dotless{i}}}
8371 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1}{\v{O}}
8372 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2}{\v{o}}
8373 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3}{\v{U}}
8374 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4}{\v{u}}
8376 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2}{\={\AE}}
8377 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3}{\={\ae}}
8378 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6}{\v{G}}
8379 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7}{\v{g}}
8380 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8}{\v{K}}
8381 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9}{\v{k}}
8383 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0}{\v{\dotless{j}}}
8384 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1}{DZ}
8385 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2}{Dz}
8386 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3}{dz}
8387 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4}{\'G}
8388 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5}{\'g}
8389 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8}{\`N}
8390 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9}{\`n}
8391 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC}{\'{\AE}}
8392 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD}{\'{\ae}}
8393 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE}{\'{\O}}
8394 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF}{\'{\o}}
8396 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E}{\v{H}}
8397 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F}{\v{h}}
8399 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A}}
8400 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a}}
8401 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E}}
8402 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e}}
8403 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E}{\dotaccent{O}}
8404 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F}{\dotaccent{o}}
8406 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y}
8407 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y}
8408 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j}}
8410 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02}{\dotaccent{B}}
8411 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03}{\dotaccent{b}}
8412 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04}{\udotaccent{B}}
8413 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05}{\udotaccent{b}}
8414 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06}{\ubaraccent{B}}
8415 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07}{\ubaraccent{b}}
8416 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A}{\dotaccent{D}}
8417 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B}{\dotaccent{d}}
8418 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C}{\udotaccent{D}}
8419 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D}{\udotaccent{d}}
8420 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E}{\ubaraccent{D}}
8421 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F}{\ubaraccent{d}}
8423 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E}{\dotaccent{F}}
8424 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F}{\dotaccent{f}}
8426 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20}{\=G}
8427 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21}{\=g}
8428 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22}{\dotaccent{H}}
8429 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23}{\dotaccent{h}}
8430 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24}{\udotaccent{H}}
8431 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25}{\udotaccent{h}}
8432 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26}{\"H}
8433 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27}{\"h}
8435 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30}{\'K}
8436 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31}{\'k}
8437 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32}{\udotaccent{K}}
8438 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33}{\udotaccent{k}}
8439 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34}{\ubaraccent{K}}
8440 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35}{\ubaraccent{k}}
8441 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36}{\udotaccent{L}}
8442 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37}{\udotaccent{l}}
8443 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A}{\ubaraccent{L}}
8444 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B}{\ubaraccent{l}}
8445 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E}{\'M}
8446 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F}{\'m}
8448 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40}{\dotaccent{M}}
8449 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41}{\dotaccent{m}}
8450 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42}{\udotaccent{M}}
8451 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43}{\udotaccent{m}}
8452 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44}{\dotaccent{N}}
8453 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45}{\dotaccent{n}}
8454 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46}{\udotaccent{N}}
8455 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47}{\udotaccent{n}}
8456 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48}{\ubaraccent{N}}
8457 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49}{\ubaraccent{n}}
8459 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54}{\'P}
8460 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55}{\'p}
8461 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56}{\dotaccent{P}}
8462 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57}{\dotaccent{p}}
8463 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58}{\dotaccent{R}}
8464 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59}{\dotaccent{r}}
8465 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A}{\udotaccent{R}}
8466 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B}{\udotaccent{r}}
8467 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E}{\ubaraccent{R}}
8468 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F}{\ubaraccent{r}}
8470 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60}{\dotaccent{S}}
8471 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61}{\dotaccent{s}}
8472 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62}{\udotaccent{S}}
8473 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63}{\udotaccent{s}}
8474 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A}{\dotaccent{T}}
8475 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B}{\dotaccent{t}}
8476 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C}{\udotaccent{T}}
8477 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D}{\udotaccent{t}}
8478 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E}{\ubaraccent{T}}
8479 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F}{\ubaraccent{t}}
8481 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C}{\~V}
8482 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D}{\~v}
8483 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E}{\udotaccent{V}}
8484 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F}{\udotaccent{v}}
8486 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80}{\`W}
8487 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81}{\`w}
8488 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82}{\'W}
8489 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83}{\'w}
8490 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84}{\"W}
8491 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85}{\"w}
8492 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86}{\dotaccent{W}}
8493 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87}{\dotaccent{w}}
8494 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88}{\udotaccent{W}}
8495 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89}{\udotaccent{w}}
8496 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A}{\dotaccent{X}}
8497 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B}{\dotaccent{x}}
8498 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C}{\"X}
8499 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D}{\"x}
8500 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E}{\dotaccent{Y}}
8501 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F}{\dotaccent{y}}
8503 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90}{\^Z}
8504 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91}{\^z}
8505 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92}{\udotaccent{Z}}
8506 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93}{\udotaccent{z}}
8507 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94}{\ubaraccent{Z}}
8508 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95}{\ubaraccent{z}}
8509 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96}{\ubaraccent{h}}
8510 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97}{\"t}
8511 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98}{\ringaccent{w}}
8512 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99}{\ringaccent{y}}
8514 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0}{\udotaccent{A}}
8515 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1}{\udotaccent{a}}
8517 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8}{\udotaccent{E}}
8518 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9}{\udotaccent{e}}
8519 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC}{\~E}
8520 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD}{\~e}
8522 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA}{\udotaccent{I}}
8523 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB}{\udotaccent{i}}
8524 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC}{\udotaccent{O}}
8525 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD}{\udotaccent{o}}
8527 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4}{\udotaccent{U}}
8528 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5}{\udotaccent{u}}
8530 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2}{\`Y}
8531 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3}{\`y}
8532 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4}{\udotaccent{Y}}
8534 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8}{\~Y}
8535 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9}{\~y}
8537 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--}
8538 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---}
8539 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft}
8540 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright}
8541 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A}{\quotesinglbase}
8542 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C}{\quotedblleft}
8543 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D}{\quotedblright}
8544 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E}{\quotedblbase}
8545 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet}
8546 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots}
8547 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft}
8548 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A}{\guilsinglright}
8549 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC}{\euro}
8551 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion}
8552 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2}{\result}
8554 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus}
8555 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\point}
8556 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv}
8557 }% end of \utfeightchardefs
8560 % US-ASCII character definitions.
8561 \def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
8562 \relax
8565 % Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with
8566 % existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a
8567 % document encoding.
8569 \setnonasciicharscatcode \other
8572 \message{formatting,}
8574 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt
8576 \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt
8577 \secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt
8578 \subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt
8580 % Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
8581 \vbadness = 10000
8583 % Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
8584 \hbadness = 2000
8586 % Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans.
8587 \widowpenalty=10000
8588 \clubpenalty=10000
8590 % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
8591 % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
8592 % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
8593 % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set.
8595 \def\setemergencystretch{%
8596 \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
8597 % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
8598 \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
8599 \else
8600 \emergencystretch = .15\hsize
8604 % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
8605 % 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
8606 % 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
8608 % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
8609 % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
8611 \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
8612 \voffset = #3\relax
8613 \topskip = #6\relax
8614 \splittopskip = \topskip
8616 \vsize = #1\relax
8617 \advance\vsize by \topskip
8618 \outervsize = \vsize
8619 \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin
8620 \pageheight = \vsize
8622 \hsize = #2\relax
8623 \outerhsize = \hsize
8624 \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in
8625 \pagewidth = \hsize
8627 \normaloffset = #4\relax
8628 \bindingoffset = #5\relax
8630 \ifpdf
8631 \pdfpageheight #7\relax
8632 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
8633 % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of
8634 % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with.
8635 \pdfhorigin = 1 true in
8636 \pdfvorigin = 1 true in
8639 \setleading{\textleading}
8641 \parindent = \defaultparindent
8642 \setemergencystretch
8645 % @letterpaper (the default).
8646 \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
8647 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
8648 \textleading = 13.2pt
8650 % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
8651 \internalpagesizes{607.2pt}{6in}% that's 46 lines
8652 {\voffset}{.25in}%
8653 {\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
8654 {11in}{8.5in}%
8657 % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
8658 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1
8659 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt
8660 \textleading = 12pt
8662 \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}%
8663 {-.2in}{0in}%
8664 {\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
8665 {9.25in}{7in}%
8667 \lispnarrowing = 0.3in
8668 \tolerance = 700
8669 \hfuzz = 1pt
8670 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
8671 \defbodyindent = .5cm
8674 % Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
8675 % (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
8676 \def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1
8677 \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt
8678 \textleading = 12pt
8680 \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}%
8681 {-.2in}{-.4in}%
8682 {0pt}{14pt}%
8683 {9in}{6in}%
8685 \lispnarrowing = 0.25in
8686 \tolerance = 700
8687 \hfuzz = 1pt
8688 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
8689 \defbodyindent = .4cm
8692 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
8693 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
8694 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
8695 \textleading = 13.2pt
8697 % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
8698 % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
8699 % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
8700 % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
8701 % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
8702 % your texinfo source file like this:
8703 % @tex
8704 % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
8705 % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
8706 % @end tex
8707 \internalpagesizes{673.2pt}{160mm}% that's 51 lines
8708 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
8709 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
8710 {297mm}{210mm}%
8712 \tolerance = 700
8713 \hfuzz = 1pt
8714 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
8715 \defbodyindent = 5mm
8718 % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
8719 % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
8720 % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
8721 \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1
8722 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt
8723 \textleading = 12.5pt
8725 \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}%
8726 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
8727 {\bindingoffset}{8pt}%
8728 {210mm}{148mm}%
8730 \lispnarrowing = 0.2in
8731 \tolerance = 800
8732 \hfuzz = 1.2pt
8733 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
8734 \defbodyindent = 2mm
8735 \tableindent = 12mm
8738 % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
8739 \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1
8740 \afourpaper
8741 \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}%
8742 {\voffset}{4.6mm}%
8743 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
8744 {297mm}{210mm}%
8746 % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
8747 \globaldefs = 0
8750 % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
8751 \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1
8752 \afourpaper
8753 \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}%
8754 {\voffset}{-2.95mm}%
8755 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
8756 {297mm}{210mm}%
8757 \globaldefs = 0
8760 % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
8761 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
8762 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
8764 \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
8765 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{%
8766 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi
8767 \globaldefs = 1
8769 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
8770 \setleading{\textleading}%
8772 \dimen0 = #1\relax
8773 \advance\dimen0 by \voffset
8775 \dimen2 = \hsize
8776 \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset
8778 \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
8779 {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
8780 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
8781 {\dimen0}{\dimen2}%
8784 % Set default to letter.
8786 \letterpaper
8789 \message{and turning on texinfo input format.}
8791 % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
8792 \catcode`\"=\other
8793 \catcode`\~=\other
8794 \catcode`\^=\other
8795 \catcode`\_=\other
8796 \catcode`\|=\other
8797 \catcode`\<=\other
8798 \catcode`\>=\other
8799 \catcode`\+=\other
8800 \catcode`\$=\other
8801 \def\normaldoublequote{"}
8802 \def\normaltilde{~}
8803 \def\normalcaret{^}
8804 \def\normalunderscore{_}
8805 \def\normalverticalbar{|}
8806 \def\normalless{<}
8807 \def\normalgreater{>}
8808 \def\normalplus{+}
8809 \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
8811 % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
8812 % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
8813 % where something hairier probably needs to be done.
8815 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
8816 % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
8817 % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
8818 % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
8820 \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi}
8822 % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches
8823 % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
8824 % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
8825 % this is not a problem.
8826 \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi}
8828 % Turn off all special characters except @
8829 % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary).
8830 % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
8831 % use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
8833 \catcode`\"=\active
8834 \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
8835 \let"=\activedoublequote
8836 \catcode`\~=\active
8837 \def~{{\tt\char126}}
8838 \chardef\hat=`\^
8839 \catcode`\^=\active
8840 \def^{{\tt \hat}}
8842 \catcode`\_=\active
8843 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
8844 \let\realunder=_
8845 % Subroutine for the previous macro.
8846 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }
8848 \catcode`\|=\active
8849 \def|{{\tt\char124}}
8850 \chardef \less=`\<
8851 \catcode`\<=\active
8852 \def<{{\tt \less}}
8853 \chardef \gtr=`\>
8854 \catcode`\>=\active
8855 \def>{{\tt \gtr}}
8856 \catcode`\+=\active
8857 \def+{{\tt \char 43}}
8858 \catcode`\$=\active
8859 \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
8861 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
8862 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
8863 % So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on.
8864 % \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file.
8865 \def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other}
8867 % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
8868 % parsing them.
8869 \def\turnoffactive{%
8870 \normalturnoffactive
8871 \otherbackslash
8874 \catcode`\@=0
8876 % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
8877 % as in \char`\\.
8878 \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
8879 \global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work
8881 % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and
8882 % \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
8883 {\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\} @gdef@doublebackslash{\\}}
8885 % In texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
8886 % in fixed width font.
8887 \catcode`\\=\active
8888 @def@normalbackslash{{@tt@backslashcurfont}}
8889 % On startup, @fixbackslash assigns:
8890 % @let \ = @normalbackslash
8892 % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
8893 % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
8894 % catcode other.
8895 @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont}
8896 @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash}
8898 % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
8899 % the literal character `\'.
8901 @def@normalturnoffactive{%
8902 @let\=@normalbackslash
8903 @let"=@normaldoublequote
8904 @let~=@normaltilde
8905 @let^=@normalcaret
8906 @let_=@normalunderscore
8907 @let|=@normalverticalbar
8908 @let<=@normalless
8909 @let>=@normalgreater
8910 @let+=@normalplus
8911 @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
8912 @unsepspaces
8915 % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily.
8916 % This is canceled by @fixbackslash.
8917 @otherifyactive
8919 % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
8920 % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
8921 % a backslash.
8923 @gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash}
8924 @global@let\ = @eatinput
8926 % On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then
8927 % the first `\' in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
8928 % that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur.
8929 % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
8930 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
8932 @gdef@fixbackslash{%
8933 @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi
8934 @catcode`+=@active
8935 @catcode`@_=@active
8938 % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
8939 @escapechar = `@@
8941 % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
8942 @catcode`@& = @other
8943 @catcode`@# = @other
8944 @catcode`@% = @other
8947 @c Local variables:
8948 @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
8949 @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message"
8950 @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{"
8951 @c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
8952 @c time-stamp-end: "}"
8953 @c End:
8955 @c vim:sw=2:
8957 @ignore
8958 arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115
8959 @end ignore